blob: cdac65c4b2515969dd7e14b1735d1729a74d7879 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaua3393952014-05-10 15:16:43 +02007 2014/05/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100500 - tune.zlib.memlevel
501 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503 * Debugging
504 - debug
505 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506
507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005083.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200509------------------------------------
510
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200511ca-base <dir>
512 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200513 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
514 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200515
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516chroot <jail dir>
517 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
518 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
519 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
520 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
521 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
522 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100523
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100524cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
525 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
526 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
527 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100528 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
529 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
530 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
531 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
532 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
533 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
534 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
535 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
536 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
537 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100538
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200539crt-base <dir>
540 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
541 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
542 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
543
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544daemon
545 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
546 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
547 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
548
549gid <number>
550 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
551 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
552 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100553 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
554 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200555 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100556
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557group <group name>
558 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
559 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100560
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200561log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
563 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100564 configured with "log global".
565
566 <address> can be one of:
567
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100568 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100569 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
570 port).
571
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100572 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
573 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
574 port).
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
577 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
578 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
579 writeable).
580
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100581 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
582 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
583 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
584 in Bourne shell.
585
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100586 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587
588 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
589 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
590 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
591
592 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200593 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
594 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
595 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
596 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
597 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
598 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200600 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100602log-send-hostname [<string>]
603 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
604 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
605 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
606 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
607 the logs.
608
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000609log-tag <string>
610 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
611 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
612 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
613 running on the same host.
614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615nbproc <number>
616 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
617 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
618 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
619 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
620 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
621
622pidfile <pidfile>
623 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
624 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
625 starting the process. See also "daemon".
626
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100627stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200628 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
629 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
630 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
631 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
632 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
633 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100634 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200635 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
636 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200637
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100638ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
639 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
640 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100642 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
643 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
644 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
645 "bind" keyword for more information.
646
647ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
648 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
649 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300650 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
652 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
653 information.
654
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100655ssl-server-verify [none|required]
656 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
657 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
658 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
659
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200660stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
661 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
662 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
663 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
664 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200665
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200666 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
667 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
668 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200669
670stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
671 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
672 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100673 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200674
675stats maxconn <connections>
676 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
677 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200679uid <number>
680 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
681 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
682 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
683 one. See also "gid" and "user".
684
685ulimit-n <number>
686 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
687 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
688 option.
689
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100690unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
691 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
692
693 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
694 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
695 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
696 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
697 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
698 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
699 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
700 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
701 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
702 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704user <user name>
705 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
706 See also "uid" and "group".
707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200708node <name>
709 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
710
711 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
712 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
713 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
714 traffic.
715
716description <text>
717 Add a text that describes the instance.
718
719 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
720 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
721 "<" and ">" characters.
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007243.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725-----------------------
726
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200727max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
728 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
729 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
730 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
731 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
732 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
733 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
734 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
735 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737maxconn <number>
738 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
739 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
740 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
741 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
742
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200743maxconnrate <number>
744 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
745 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
746 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
747 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
748 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
749 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
750 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
751 fairness.
752
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100753maxcomprate <number>
754 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300755 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100756 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
757 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
758 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
759 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
760 default value.
761
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100762maxcompcpuusage <number>
763 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
764 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
765 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
766 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
767 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
768 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
769 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
770 process down and from introducing high latencies.
771
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100772maxpipes <number>
773 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
774 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
775 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
776 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
777 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
778 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
779
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200780maxsessrate <number>
781 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
782 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
783 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
784 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
785 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
786 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
787 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
788 fairness.
789
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200790maxsslconn <number>
791 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
792 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
793 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
794 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
795 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
796 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
797 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
798
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200799maxsslrate <number>
800 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
801 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
802 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
803 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
804 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
805 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
806 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
807 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
808 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
809 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
810
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100811maxzlibmem <number>
812 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
813 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
814 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100815 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
816 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
817 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819noepoll
820 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
821 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100822 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823
824nokqueue
825 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
826 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
827 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
828
829nopoll
830 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
831 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100832 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100833 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200834
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100835nosplice
836 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
837 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
838 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100839 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100840 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
841 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
842 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
843 "option splice-response".
844
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300845nogetaddrinfo
846 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
847 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
848
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200849spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900850 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
851 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
852 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
853 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
854 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
855 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200856
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200857tune.bufsize <number>
858 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
859 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
860 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
861 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
862 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
863 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
864 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
865 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400866 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
867 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
868 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200869
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200870tune.chksize <number>
871 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
872 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
873 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
874 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
875 checks whenever possible.
876
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100877tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
878 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
879 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
880 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
881 this value. The default value is 1.
882
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100883tune.http.cookielen <number>
884 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
885 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
886 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
887 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
888 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
889 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
890 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
891 to change this value.
892
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200893tune.http.maxhdr <number>
894 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
895 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
896 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
897 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
898 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
899 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
900 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
901 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
902 limit too high.
903
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100904tune.idletimer <timeout>
905 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
906 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
907 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
908 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
909 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
910 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
911 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
912 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
913 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
914
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100915tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100916 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
917 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
918 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
919 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
920 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
921 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
922 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
923 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
924 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
925 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100926
927tune.maxpollevents <number>
928 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
929 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
930 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
931 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
932 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
933
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200934tune.maxrewrite <number>
935 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
936 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
937 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
938 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
939 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
940 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
941 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
942 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
943 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
944 bufsize.
945
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200946tune.pipesize <number>
947 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
948 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
949 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
950 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
951 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
952 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
953
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100954tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
955tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
956 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
957 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
958 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
959 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
960 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
961 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
962 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
963
964tune.sndbuf.client <number>
965tune.sndbuf.server <number>
966 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
967 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
968 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
969 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
970 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
971 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
972 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
973 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
974 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
975 notifying haproxy again.
976
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100977tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100978 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
979 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
980 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300981 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100982 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
983 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
984 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
985 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
986 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100987 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
988 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100989
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200990tune.ssl.force-private-cache
991 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
992 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
993 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
994 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
995 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
996 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
997
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100998tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
999 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001000 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001001 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1002 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1003 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1004 being used for too long.
1005
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001006tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1007 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1008 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1009 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1010 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1011 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1012 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1013 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1014 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1015 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1016 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001017 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1018 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001019
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001020tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1021 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001022 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001023 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1024 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1025 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1026
1027tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1028 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1029 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1030 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1031 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010333.3. Debugging
1034--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035
1036debug
1037 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1038 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1039 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1040 system startup.
1041
1042quiet
1043 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1044 line argument "-q".
1045
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010473.4. Userlists
1048--------------
1049It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1050http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1051it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1052
1053userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001054 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001055 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1056
1057group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001058 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001059 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1060 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001062user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1063 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001064 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1065 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001066 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1067 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001068 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001069 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001070
1071
1072 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001073 userlist L1
1074 group G1 users tiger,scott
1075 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001076
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001077 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1078 user scott insecure-password elgato
1079 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001080
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001081 userlist L2
1082 group G1
1083 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001084
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001085 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1086 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1087 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001088
1089 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001091
10923.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001093----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001094It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1095haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1096pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1097identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1098or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1099Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1100known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1101the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1102process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1103during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1104tables.
1105
1106peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001107 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001108 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1109
1110peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1111 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1112 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1113 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1114 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1115 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1116 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1117
1118 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1119 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1120
1121 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1122 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1123 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1124 across all peers.
1125
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001126 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1127 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1128 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1129
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001130 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001131 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001132 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1133 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1134 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135
1136 backend mybackend
1137 mode tcp
1138 balance roundrobin
1139 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1140 stick on src
1141
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001142 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1143 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001144
1145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011464. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001147----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1150 - defaults <name>
1151 - frontend <name>
1152 - backend <name>
1153 - listen <name>
1154
1155A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1156its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1157section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159
1160A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1161connections.
1162
1163A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1164to forward incoming connections.
1165
1166A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1167parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001169All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1170'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1171case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1172
1173Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1174logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1175proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1176However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1177name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1178
1179Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1180and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001181bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001182protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1183modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1184arbitrary criteria.
1185
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001186In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1187a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1188the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1189
1190 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1191 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1192 between responses and new requests.
1193
1194 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1195 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1196 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1197 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1198
1199 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1200 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1201 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1202
1203 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1204 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1205 client-facing connection remains open.
1206
1207 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1208 after the end of the response.
1209
1210The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1211frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1212following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1213weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1214
1215 Backend mode
1216
1217 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1218 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1219 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1220 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1221 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1222 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1223 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1224 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1225 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1226 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1227 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001229
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012314.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1232--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001234The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1235limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1236they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1237limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001238marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001239option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001240and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1241with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1242specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001244
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001245 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1246------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1247acl - X X X
1248appsession - - X X
1249backlog X X X -
1250balance X - X X
1251bind - X X -
1252bind-process X X X X
1253block - X X X
1254capture cookie - X X -
1255capture request header - X X -
1256capture response header - X X -
1257clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001258compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001259contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1260cookie X - X X
1261default-server X - X X
1262default_backend X X X -
1263description - X X X
1264disabled X X X X
1265dispatch - - X X
1266enabled X X X X
1267errorfile X X X X
1268errorloc X X X X
1269errorloc302 X X X X
1270-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1271errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001272force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273fullconn X - X X
1274grace X X X X
1275hash-type X - X X
1276http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001277http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001278http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001280http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001281http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001282id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001283ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001284log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001285max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286maxconn X X X -
1287mode X X X X
1288monitor fail - X X -
1289monitor-net X X X -
1290monitor-uri X X X -
1291option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1292option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1293option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1294option allbackups (*) X - X X
1295option checkcache (*) X - X X
1296option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1297option contstats (*) X X X -
1298option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1299option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1300option forceclose (*) X X X X
1301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1302option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001303option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001304option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001305option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001307option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001308option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1309option httpchk X - X X
1310option httpclose (*) X X X X
1311option httplog X X X X
1312option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001313option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001314option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001315option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1316option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1317option logasap (*) X X X -
1318option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001319option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320option nolinger (*) X X X X
1321option originalto X X X X
1322option persist (*) X - X X
1323option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001324option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001325option smtpchk X - X X
1326option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1327option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1328option splice-request (*) X X X X
1329option splice-response (*) X X X X
1330option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1331option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1332-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001333option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001334option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1335option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1336option tcpka X X X X
1337option tcplog X X X X
1338option transparent (*) X - X X
1339persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1340rate-limit sessions X X X -
1341redirect - X X X
1342redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1343redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1344reqadd - X X X
1345reqallow - X X X
1346reqdel - X X X
1347reqdeny - X X X
1348reqiallow - X X X
1349reqidel - X X X
1350reqideny - X X X
1351reqipass - X X X
1352reqirep - X X X
1353reqisetbe - X X X
1354reqitarpit - X X X
1355reqpass - X X X
1356reqrep - X X X
1357-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1358reqsetbe - X X X
1359reqtarpit - X X X
1360retries X - X X
1361rspadd - X X X
1362rspdel - X X X
1363rspdeny - X X X
1364rspidel - X X X
1365rspideny - X X X
1366rspirep - X X X
1367rsprep - X X X
1368server - - X X
1369source X - X X
1370srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001371stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001372stats auth X - X X
1373stats enable X - X X
1374stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001375stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376stats realm X - X X
1377stats refresh X - X X
1378stats scope X - X X
1379stats show-desc X - X X
1380stats show-legends X - X X
1381stats show-node X - X X
1382stats uri X - X X
1383-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1384stick match - - X X
1385stick on - - X X
1386stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001387stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001388stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001389tcp-check connect - - X X
1390tcp-check expect - - X X
1391tcp-check send - - X X
1392tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001393tcp-request connection - X X -
1394tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001395tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001396tcp-response content - - X X
1397tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001398timeout check X - X X
1399timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001400timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001401timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1402timeout connect X - X X
1403timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1404timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1405timeout http-request X X X X
1406timeout queue X - X X
1407timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001408timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001409timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1410timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001411timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001413unique-id-format X X X -
1414unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001415use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001416use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001417------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1418 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014214.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1422---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001423
1424This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1425
1426
1427acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1428 Declare or complete an access list.
1429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1430 no | yes | yes | yes
1431 Example:
1432 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1433 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1434 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001436 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437
1438
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001439appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1440 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001441 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1443 no | no | yes | yes
1444 Arguments :
1445 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1446 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1447
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001448 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001449 checked in each cookie value.
1450
1451 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1452 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1453 milliseconds.
1454
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001455 request-learn
1456 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1457 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1458 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1459 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1460 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1461 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1462
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001463 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1464 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1465 data following this prefix.
1466
1467 Example :
1468 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1469
1470 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1471 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1472
1473 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1474 2 modes are currently supported :
1475 - path-parameters :
1476 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1477 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1478 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1479 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1480 - query-string :
1481 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1482 query string.
1483
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001484 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1485 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1486 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1487 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001488 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1489 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1490 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1492 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1493
1494 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1495
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001496 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1497 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1498 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001500 Example :
1501 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1502
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001503 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1504 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001505
1506
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001507backlog <conns>
1508 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1510 yes | yes | yes | no
1511 Arguments :
1512 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1513 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001514 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001515
1516 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1517 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1518 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1519 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1520 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1521 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1522 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1523 backlog parameter.
1524
1525 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1526 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1527 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1528
1529 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1530
1531
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001532balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001533balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001534 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1536 yes | no | yes | yes
1537 Arguments :
1538 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1539 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1540 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1541 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1542
1543 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1544 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1545 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1546 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001547 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001548 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001549 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1550 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1551 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1552 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1553 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1554 it, so that you don't worry.
1555
1556 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1557 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1558 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1559 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1560 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1561 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1562 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1563 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001564
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001565 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1566 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1567 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1568 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1569 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1570 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1571 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1572 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1573
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001574 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001575 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001576 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1577 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001578 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001579 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1580 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1581 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1582 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1583 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001584 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1585 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1586 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1587 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1588 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1589 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1592 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1593 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1594 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1595 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1596 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1597 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1598 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001599 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001601 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1602 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1603 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001604
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001605 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1606 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1607 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1608 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1609 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1610 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1611 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1612 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1613 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1614 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1615 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1616 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001617
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001618 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001619 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1620 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1621 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1622 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1623 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1624 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1625 URIs start with a leading "/".
1626
1627 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1628 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1629 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1630 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001633 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1634
1635 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001636 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1637 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001638 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1639 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1640 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1641 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001642 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001643 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1644 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001645
1646 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1647 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1648 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1649 server will receive the request.
1650
1651 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1652 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1653 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1654 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1655 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001656 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1657 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1658 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001659
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001660 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1661 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1662 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1663 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1664 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001666 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001667 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1668 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1669 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1670
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001671 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1672 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1673 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1674
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001675 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001676 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001677 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1678 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1679 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1680 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1681 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1682 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001683 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001684 used instead.
1685
1686 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1687 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1688 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1689 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1690
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001691 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1692 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1693 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1694
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001695 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001696
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001697 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001698 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1699 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001700
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001701 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1702 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1703 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
1705 Examples :
1706 balance roundrobin
1707 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001708 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001709 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1710 balance hdr(host)
1711 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001712
1713 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1714 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001716 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001717 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1718 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1719 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1720 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1721
1722 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1723 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1724 defaults to 16 kB.
1725
1726 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1727 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1728
1729 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1730 Round Robin.
1731
1732 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1733 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1734 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1735 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1736
1737 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1738
1739 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001740 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001741 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1742 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1743 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001744
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001745 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1746 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747
1748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001749bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1750bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001751 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1753 no | yes | yes | no
1754 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001755 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1756 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1757 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1758 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001759 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001760 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1761 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1762 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1763 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1764 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1765 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1766 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02001767 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001768 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1769 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1770 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001771 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1772 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1773 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1774 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001775
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001776 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1777 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001778 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1779 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1780 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001781 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1782 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1783 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1784 the range.
1785
1786 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1787 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1788 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1789 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1790 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1791 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1792 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001793 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001794 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001796 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1797 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1798 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1799 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1800 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1801 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1802 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1803 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1804
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001805 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1806 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1807 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1808 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1811 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1812 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1813 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1814 in a frontend.
1815
1816 Example :
1817 listen http_proxy
1818 bind :80,:443
1819 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001820 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001822 listen http_https_proxy
1823 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001824 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001825
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001826 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1827 bind ipv6@:80
1828 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1829 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1830
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001831 listen external_bind_app1
1832 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1833
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001834 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001835 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001836
1837
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001838bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001839 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1841 yes | yes | yes | yes
1842 Arguments :
1843 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1844 may be used to override a default value.
1845
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001846 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001847 option may be combined with other numbers.
1848
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001849 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001850 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1851 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1852 missing from all processes.
1853
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001854 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001855 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001856 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1857 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1858 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1859 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001860
1861 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1862 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1863 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1864 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1865 and 'even' instances.
1866
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001867 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1868 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1869 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1870 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001871
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001872 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1873 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1874
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001875 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1876 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1877
1878 Example :
1879 listen app_ip1
1880 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001881 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001882
1883 listen app_ip2
1884 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001885 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001886
1887 listen management
1888 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001889 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001890
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001891 listen management
1892 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1893 bind-process 1-4
1894
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001895 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001896
1897
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001898block { if | unless } <condition>
1899 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1901 no | yes | yes | yes
1902
1903 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1904 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001905 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001906 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001907 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1908 "block" statements per instance.
1909
1910 Example:
1911 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1912 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1913 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1914 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001916 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001917
1918
1919capture cookie <name> len <length>
1920 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1922 no | yes | yes | no
1923 Arguments :
1924 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1925 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1926 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1927 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1928 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1929
1930 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1931 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1932 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1933 right if it exceeds <length>.
1934
1935 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1936 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1937 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1938 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1939
1940 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1941 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1942 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1943
1944 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1945 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1946 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001947 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1948 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1949 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950
1951 Example:
1952 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1953
1954 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001955 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
1957
1958capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001959 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1961 no | yes | yes | no
1962 Arguments :
1963 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001964 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1966 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1967 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1968
1969 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1970 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1971 it exceeds <length>.
1972
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001973 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1975 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001976 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1977 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1978 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1979 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001980 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001981 environments to find where the request came from.
1982
1983 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1984 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1985 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1986 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001988 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1989 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1990 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1991 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1992 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
1994 Example:
1995 capture request header Host len 15
1996 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1997 capture request header Referrer len 15
1998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001999 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000 about logging.
2001
2002
2003capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002004 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2006 no | yes | yes | no
2007 Arguments :
2008 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002009 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2011 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2012 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2013
2014 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2015 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2016 it exceeds <length>.
2017
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002018 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2020 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2021 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002022 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2023 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2024 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2025 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002027 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2028 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2029 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2030 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2031 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002032
2033 Example:
2034 capture response header Content-length len 9
2035 capture response header Location len 15
2036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002037 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038 about logging.
2039
2040
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002041clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2044 yes | yes | yes | no
2045 Arguments :
2046 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2047 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2048 as explained at the top of this document.
2049
2050 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2051 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2052 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2053 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2054 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2055 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2056 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2057 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002058 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002059 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2060 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2061
2062 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2063 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2064 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2065 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2066 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2067 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2068
2069 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2070 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2071
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002072 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2073 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002075compression algo <algorithm> ...
2076compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002077compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002078 Enable HTTP compression.
2079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2080 yes | yes | yes | yes
2081 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002082 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2083 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2084 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2085
2086 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002087 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002088 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2089 data.
2090
2091 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2092 support for zlib was built in.
2093
2094 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2095 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2096 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2097 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2098 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2099 in.
2100
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002101 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002102 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002103 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2104 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2105 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2106 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2107 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002108
2109 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2110 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2111 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2112 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2113 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002114 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2115 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2116 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2117 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2118 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2119 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002120
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002121 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002122 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2123 "Accept-Encoding" header
2124 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002125 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002126 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2127 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002128 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2129 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2130 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2131 "multipart"
2132 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2133 header
2134 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2135 and later
2136 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2137 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002138
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002139 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2140 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002141
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002142 Examples :
2143 compression algo gzip
2144 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002145
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002146contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2149 yes | no | yes | yes
2150 Arguments :
2151 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2153 as explained at the top of this document.
2154
2155 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002156 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002157 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2159 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2160 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2161 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2162
2163 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2164 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2165 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2166 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2167 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2168 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2169
2170 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2171 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2172 instead.
2173
2174 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2175 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2176
2177
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002178cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002179 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2180 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002181 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2183 yes | no | yes | yes
2184 Arguments :
2185 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2186 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2187 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2188 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2189 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2190 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2191 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2192 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2193 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2194
2195 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2196 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2197 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2198 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2199 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2200 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2201 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2202 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2203 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2204 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2205 "insert" and "prefix".
2206
2207 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002208 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002209
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002210 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002211 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2212 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2213 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2214 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2215 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2216 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2217 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2218 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2219 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2220 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002221
2222 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2223 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2224 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2225 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2226 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2227 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2228 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2229 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2230 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2231 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002232 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2233 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2234 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002235
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002236 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2237 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2238 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002239 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2240 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2241 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2242 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002243 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2244 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2245 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002246
2247 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2248 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2249 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2250 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2251 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2252 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2253 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2254 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2255 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2256
2257 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2258 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2259 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2260 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2261 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2262 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2263 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2264 persistence cookie in the cache.
2265 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2266
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002267 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2268 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2269 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2270 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2271 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2272 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2273 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2274 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2275 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2276 they logout.
2277
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002278 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2279 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2280 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2281 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2282
2283 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2284 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2285 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2286 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2287 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2288 this attribute.
2289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002290 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002291 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002292 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2293 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2294 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2295 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2296 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2297 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002298
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002299 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2300 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2301 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2302 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2303 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2304 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2305 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2306 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2307 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2308 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2309 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2310 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2311 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2312 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2313 the site.
2314
2315 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2316 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2317 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2318 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2319 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2320 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2321 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2322 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2323 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2324 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2325 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2326 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2327 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2328 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2329 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2330 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2333 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2334 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2335 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002337 Examples :
2338 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2339 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2340 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002341 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002343 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002344 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002347default-server [param*]
2348 Change default options for a server in a backend
2349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2350 yes | no | yes | yes
2351 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002352 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2353 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2354 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2355 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002356
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002357 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002358 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2359
2360 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002361
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363default_backend <backend>
2364 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2366 yes | yes | yes | no
2367 Arguments :
2368 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2369
2370 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2371 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2372 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2373 will catch all undetermined requests.
2374
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 Example :
2376
2377 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2378 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2379 default_backend dynamic
2380
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002381 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2382
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002384description <string>
2385 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2387 no | yes | yes | yes
2388 Arguments : string
2389
2390 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2391 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2392 it describes.
2393 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2394
2395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396disabled
2397 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2399 yes | yes | yes | yes
2400 Arguments : none
2401
2402 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2403 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2404 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2405 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2406 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2407 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2408 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2409
2410 See also : "enabled"
2411
2412
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002413dispatch <address>:<port>
2414 Set a default server address
2415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2416 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002417 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002418
2419 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2420 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2421 during start-up.
2422
2423 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2424 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2425 possible with normal servers.
2426
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002427 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002428 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2429 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2430 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2431 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2432
2433 See also : "server"
2434
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436enabled
2437 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2439 yes | yes | yes | yes
2440 Arguments : none
2441
2442 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2443 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2444
2445 See also : "disabled"
2446
2447
2448errorfile <code> <file>
2449 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 yes | yes | yes | yes
2452 Arguments :
2453 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002454 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
2456 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002457 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002459 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2460 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
2462 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2463 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2464 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2465
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002466 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2469 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2470 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2471 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2472
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002473 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2474 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2475 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2476 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2477 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2478 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2481 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2482 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002483 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002484 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2485
2486 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2487
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002488 Example :
2489 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2490 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2491 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2492
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002493
2494errorloc <code> <url>
2495errorloc302 <code> <url>
2496 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2498 yes | yes | yes | yes
2499 Arguments :
2500 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002501 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002502
2503 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2504 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2505 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2506 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2507 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2508
2509 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2510 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2511 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2512
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002513 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2514
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002515 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2516 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2517 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2518 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2519 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2520 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2521 request.
2522
2523 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2524
2525
2526errorloc303 <code> <url>
2527 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2529 yes | yes | yes | yes
2530 Arguments :
2531 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2532 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2533
2534 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2535 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2536 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2537 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2538 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2539
2540 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2541 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2542 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2543
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002544 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2545
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002546 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2547 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2548 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2549 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002550 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002551
2552 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2553
2554
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002555force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2556 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2557 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2558 no | yes | yes | yes
2559
2560 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2561 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2562 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2563 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2564 marked down for maintenance operations.
2565
2566 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2567 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2568 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2569 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2570 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2571 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2572 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2573 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2574 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2575
2576 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2577 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2578 is used.
2579
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002580 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002581 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002582
2583
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002584fullconn <conns>
2585 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2587 yes | no | yes | yes
2588 Arguments :
2589 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2590 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2591
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002592 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002593 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002594 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002595 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2596 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2597 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2598 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2599 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002600 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002601
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002602 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2603 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002604 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2605 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2606 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002607
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002608 Example :
2609 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2610 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2611 # connections.
2612 backend dynamic
2613 fullconn 10000
2614 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2615 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2616
2617 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2618
2619
2620grace <time>
2621 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002623 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002624 Arguments :
2625 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2626 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2627 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2628
2629 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2630 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002631 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002632 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2633
2634 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2635 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2636 simplify it.
2637
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002639hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002640 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2642 yes | no | yes | yes
2643 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002644 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2645 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002646
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002647 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2648 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2649 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2650 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2651 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2652 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2653 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2654 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2655 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2656 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002657
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002658 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2659 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2660 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2661 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2662 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2663 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2664 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2665 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2666 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2667 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2668 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2669 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2670 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002671 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2672 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002673
2674 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2675
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002676 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002677 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2678 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2679 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002680 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2681 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2682 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002683
2684 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2685 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002686 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2687 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2688 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2689 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2690
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002691 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2692 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2693 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2694 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2695 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2696 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2697 parameter.
2698
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002699 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2700
2701 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2702 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2703 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2704 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2705 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2706 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2707 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2708 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2709 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2710 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2711 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2712 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002713
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002714 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2715 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2716 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002717
2718 See also : "balance", "server"
2719
2720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721http-check disable-on-404
2722 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002724 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725 Arguments : none
2726
2727 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2728 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2729 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2730 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2731 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2732 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2733 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2734 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002735 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2736 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2737 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2738
2739 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2740
2741
2742http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002743 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002745 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002746 Arguments :
2747 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2748 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002749 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002750 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2751 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2752 details on the supported keywords.
2753
2754 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2755 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2756 with the usual backslash ('\').
2757
2758 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2759 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2760 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2761 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2762 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2763
2764 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002765 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002766 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2767 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2768 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2769
2770 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002771 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002772 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2773 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2774 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2775 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2776
2777 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002778 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002779 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2780 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2781 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2782 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2783 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2784 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2785 trace).
2786
2787 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002788 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002789 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2790 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2791 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2792 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2793 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2794 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2795
2796 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2797 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2798 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2799 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2800 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2801 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2802 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2803 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2804
2805 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2806 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2807
2808 Examples :
2809 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002810 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002811
2812 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002813 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002814
2815 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002816 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002817
2818 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002819 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002820
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002821 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002822
2823
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002824http-check send-state
2825 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2827 yes | no | yes | yes
2828 Arguments : none
2829
2830 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2831 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2832 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2833 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2834 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2835
2836 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2837 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2838 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2839 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2840 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2841 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2842 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2843 checked in multiple backends.
2844
2845 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2846 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2847
2848 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2849 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2850 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2851 one fails.
2852
2853 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2854 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2855 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2856
2857 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2858 server's queue.
2859
2860 Example of a header received by the application server :
2861 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2862 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2863
2864 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2865
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002866http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002867 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002868 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002869 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2870 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2871 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2872 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2873 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2874 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002875 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002876 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2877
2878 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2879 no | yes | yes | yes
2880
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002881 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2882 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2883 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2884 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2885 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002886
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002887 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2888 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2889 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2890
2891 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2892 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2893 are evaluated.
2894
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002895 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2896 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2897 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2898 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2899 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2900 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2901 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2902 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2903 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002904 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002905 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2906
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002907 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2908 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2909 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2910 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2911 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2912
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002913 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2914 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2915 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002916 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2917 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002918
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002919 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2920 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2921 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2922 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2923 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2924 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2925 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2926 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2927
2928 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2929 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2930 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2931 external users.
2932
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002933 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2934 <name>.
2935
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002936 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2937 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2938 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2939 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2940 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2941 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2942 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2943 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2944
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002945 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2946 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2947 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2948 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2949 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2950 another equipment.
2951
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002952 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2953 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2954 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2955 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2956 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2957 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2958 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2959 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2960
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002961 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2962 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2963 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2964 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2965 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2966 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2967 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2968 admin privileges.
2969
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002970 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2971 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2972 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2973 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
2974 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2975 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
2976 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
2977 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2978
2979 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2980 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2981 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2982 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2983 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
2984 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2985
2986 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2987 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2988 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2989 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2990 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
2991 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2992
2993 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2994 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2995 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
2996 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
2997 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
2998 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2999 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3000 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3001 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3002
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003003 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3004
3005 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3006 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3007 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3008 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003009
3010 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003011 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3012 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3013 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003014
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003015 http-request allow if nagios
3016 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3017 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3018 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003019
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003020 Example:
3021 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003022 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003023
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003024 Example:
3025 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3026 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3027 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3028 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3029 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3030 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3031 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3032 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3033 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3034
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003035 Example:
3036 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3037 acl add path /addacl
3038 acl del path /delacl
3039
3040 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3041
3042 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3043 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3044
3045 Example:
3046 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3047 acl setmap path /setmap
3048 acl delmap path /delmap
3049
3050 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3051
3052 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3053 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3054
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003055 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3056 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003057
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003058http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003059 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003060 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3061 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3062 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3063 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3064 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3065 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003066 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003067 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3068
3069 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3070 no | yes | yes | yes
3071
3072 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3073 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3074 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3075 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3076 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3077 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3078
3079 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3080 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3081 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3082 current section.
3083
3084 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3085 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3086 rules are evaluated.
3087
3088 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3089 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3090 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3091 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3092 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3093 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3094 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3095
3096 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3097 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3098 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3099 external users.
3100
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003101 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3102 <name>.
3103
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003104 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3105 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3106 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3107 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3108 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3109 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3110 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3111 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3112
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003113 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3114 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3115 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3116 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3117 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3118 another equipment.
3119
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003120 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3121 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3122 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3123 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3124 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3125 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3126 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3127 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3128
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003129 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3130 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3131 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3132 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3133 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3134 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3135 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3136 admin privileges.
3137
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003138 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3139 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3140 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3141 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3142 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3143 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3144 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3145 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3146
3147 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3148 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3149 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3150 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3151 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3152 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3153
3154 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3155 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3156 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3157 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3158 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3159 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3160
3161 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3162 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3163 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3164 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3165 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3166 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3167 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3168 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3169 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3170
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003171 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3172
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003173 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003174 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3175 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3176 rules.
3177
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003178 Example:
3179 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3180
3181 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3182
3183 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3184 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3185
3186 Example:
3187 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3188
3189 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3190
3191 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3192 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3193
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003194 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3195 ACL usage.
3196
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003197
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003198http-send-name-header [<header>]
3199 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3200
3201 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3202 yes | no | yes | yes
3203
3204 Arguments :
3205
3206 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3207
3208 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3209 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3210 is added with the header string proved.
3211
3212 See also : "server"
3213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003214id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003215 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3217 no | yes | yes | yes
3218 Arguments : none
3219
3220 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3221 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3222 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003223
3224
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003225ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3226 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3227 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3228 no | yes | yes | yes
3229
3230 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3231 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3232 and running).
3233
3234 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3235 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3236 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003237 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003238 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3239
3240 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3241 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3242
3243 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3244 "unless" condition is met.
3245
3246 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3247
3248
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003249log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003250log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003251no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003252 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3254 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003255
3256 Prefix :
3257 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3258 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3259 prefix does not allow arguments.
3260
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003261 Arguments :
3262 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3263 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3264 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3265 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3266 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3267 parameter.
3268
3269 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3270 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3271
3272 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3273 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3274 standard syslog port).
3275
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003276 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3277 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3278 standard syslog port).
3279
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003280 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3281 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3282 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3283 appropriately writeable).
3284
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003285 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3286 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3287 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3288 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3289
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003290 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3291
3292 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3293 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3294 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3295
3296 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3297 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3298 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003299 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3300 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3301 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3302 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3303 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003304
3305 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3306
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003307 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3308 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3309 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003310
3311 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3312 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3313 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3314 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3315
3316 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3317 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003318
3319 Example :
3320 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003321 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3322 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003323 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3324
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003325
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003326log-format <string>
3327 Allows you to custom a log line.
3328
3329 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3330
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003331
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003332max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3333 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3334 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3335 yes | no | yes | yes
3336
3337 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3338 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3339 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3340 servers.
3341
3342 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3343 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3344 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3345 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3346 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3347 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3348 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3349 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3350 picking a different server.
3351
3352 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3353 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3354 even if they have to be queued.
3355
3356 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3357 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3358
3359
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003360maxconn <conns>
3361 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3363 yes | yes | yes | no
3364 Arguments :
3365 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3366 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3367 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3368 closes.
3369
3370 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3371 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3372 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3373 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3374 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3375 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3376 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3377 properly tuned.
3378
3379 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3380 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3381 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3382
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003383 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3384
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003385 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3386
3387
3388mode { tcp|http|health }
3389 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3391 yes | yes | yes | yes
3392 Arguments :
3393 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3394 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3395 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3396 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3397
3398 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3399 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3400 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3401 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3402 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3403
3404 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003405 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3406 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3407 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3408 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3409 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3410 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3411 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003412
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003413 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3414 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3415 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003416
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003417 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003418 defaults http_instances
3419 mode http
3420
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003421 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003422
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003423
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003424monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003425 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3427 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003428 Arguments :
3429 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3430 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003431 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003432 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3433 backend and its backup.
3434
3435 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3436 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3437 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3438 servers in a list of backends.
3439
3440 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3441 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3442 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3443 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3444 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3445 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3446 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003447 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3448 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449
3450 Example:
3451 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003452 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003453 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3454 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3455 monitor-uri /site_alive
3456 monitor fail if site_dead
3457
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003458 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003459
3460
3461monitor-net <source>
3462 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3464 yes | yes | yes | no
3465 Arguments :
3466 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3467 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3468 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3469 followed by a mask.
3470
3471 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3472 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003473 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003474 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3475
3476 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3477 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3478 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3479 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003480 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3481 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3482 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003483
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003484 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3485 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3486 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3487 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3488 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3489 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003490
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003491 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3492 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003493
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003494 Example :
3495 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3496 frontend www
3497 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3498
3499 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3500
3501
3502monitor-uri <uri>
3503 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3505 yes | yes | yes | no
3506 Arguments :
3507 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3508 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3509
3510 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3511 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3512 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3513 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3514 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3515 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3516 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3517 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3518
3519 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3520 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3521 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3522 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3523 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3524 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3525
3526 Example :
3527 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3528 frontend www
3529 mode http
3530 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3531
3532 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3533
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003534
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003535option abortonclose
3536no option abortonclose
3537 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3539 yes | no | yes | yes
3540 Arguments : none
3541
3542 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3543 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3544 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3545 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003546 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003547 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3548 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3549 encountered while delivering the response.
3550
3551 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3552 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3553 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3554 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3555 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3556 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003557 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003558 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003559 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003560 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3561 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3562 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3563
3564 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3565 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3566 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3567 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3568 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3569 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3570 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3571 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003572 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003573
3574 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3575 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3576
3577 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3578
3579
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003580option accept-invalid-http-request
3581no option accept-invalid-http-request
3582 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3584 yes | yes | yes | no
3585 Arguments : none
3586
3587 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3588 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3589 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3590 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3591 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3592 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3593 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3594 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003595 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3596 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3597 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3598 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3599 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3600 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003601
3602 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3603 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3604 been confirmed.
3605
3606 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3607 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003608 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3609 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003610 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3611
3612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3614
3615 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3616 stats socket.
3617
3618
3619option accept-invalid-http-response
3620no option accept-invalid-http-response
3621 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3623 yes | no | yes | yes
3624 Arguments : none
3625
3626 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3627 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3628 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3629 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3630 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3631 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3632 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3633 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3634 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3635
3636 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3637 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3638 been confirmed.
3639
3640 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3641 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3642 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3643 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3644
3645 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3646 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3647
3648 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3649 stats socket.
3650
3651
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003652option allbackups
3653no option allbackups
3654 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3656 yes | no | yes | yes
3657 Arguments : none
3658
3659 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3660 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3661 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3662 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3663 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3664 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3665 order between the backup servers anymore.
3666
3667 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3668 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3669
3670 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3671 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3672
3673
3674option checkcache
3675no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003676 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3678 yes | no | yes | yes
3679 Arguments : none
3680
3681 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3682 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003683 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003684 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3685 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003686 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003687
3688 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003689 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003690 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003691 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3692 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003693 to the client are :
3694 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003695 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003696 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003697 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3698 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3699 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3700 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3701 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3702 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3703 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3704 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3705 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3706 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3707 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3708
3709 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003710 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003711 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003712 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003713 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3714
3715 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3716 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003717 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003718 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3719
3720 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3721 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3722
3723
3724option clitcpka
3725no option clitcpka
3726 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3728 yes | yes | yes | no
3729 Arguments : none
3730
3731 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3732 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3733 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3734 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3735
3736 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3737 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3738 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3739 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3740
3741 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3742 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3743 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3744 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3745 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3746
3747 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3748
3749 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3750 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3751 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3752
3753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3755
3756 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3757
3758
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003759option contstats
3760 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3762 yes | yes | yes | no
3763 Arguments : none
3764
3765 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3766 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3767 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3768 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3769 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3770 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3771 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3772
3773
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003774option dontlog-normal
3775no option dontlog-normal
3776 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3778 yes | yes | yes | no
3779 Arguments : none
3780
3781 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3782 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3783 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3784 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3785 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3786 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3787 logged.
3788
3789 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3790 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3791 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003793 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003794 logging.
3795
3796
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003797option dontlognull
3798no option dontlognull
3799 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | yes | yes | no
3802 Arguments : none
3803
3804 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3805 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3806 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3807 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3808 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3809 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3810 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3811
3812 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3813 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3814 would not be logged.
3815
3816 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3817 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003819 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003820
3821
3822option forceclose
3823no option forceclose
3824 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003826 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003827 Arguments : none
3828
3829 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3830 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3831 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3832 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3833 global session times in the logs.
3834
3835 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003836 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003837 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003838
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003839 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3840 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3841 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3842
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003843 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3844 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003845
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003846 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3847 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3848
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003849 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003850
3851
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003852option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003853 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3855 yes | yes | yes | yes
3856 Arguments :
3857 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3858 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003859 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003860 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003861
3862 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3863 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3864 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3865 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3866 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3867 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3868 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003869 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3870 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3871 possible that the client has already brought one.
3872
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003873 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003874 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003875 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3876 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003877 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3878 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003879
3880 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3881 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3882 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3883 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3884 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3885 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3886 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3887
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003888 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3889 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3890 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3891 are under the control of the end-user.
3892
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003893 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003894 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3895 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003896 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3897 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3898 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003899
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003900 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003901 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3902 frontend www
3903 mode http
3904 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3905
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003906 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3907 backend www
3908 mode http
3909 option forwardfor header X-Client
3910
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003911 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003912 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003913
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003914
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003915option http-keep-alive
3916no option http-keep-alive
3917 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3919 yes | yes | yes | yes
3920 Arguments : none
3921
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003922 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3923 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3924 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3925 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3926 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3927 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3928 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3929
3930 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3931 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003932 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3933 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3934 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3935 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3936 situations where this option may be useful :
3937
3938 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3939 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3940
3941 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3942 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3943
3944 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3945 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3946 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3947 request.
3948
3949 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3950 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003951 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3952 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3953 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003954
3955 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3956 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3957
3958 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3959 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3960 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3961 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3962 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3963 not set.
3964
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003965 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3966 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003967 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003968 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003969
3970 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003971 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3972 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003973
3974
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003975option http-no-delay
3976no option http-no-delay
3977 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3979 yes | yes | yes | yes
3980 Arguments : none
3981
3982 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3983 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3984 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3985 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3986 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3987 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3988 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3989 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3990 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3991 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3992 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3993 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3994 affected.
3995
3996 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3997 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3998 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3999 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4000 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4001 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4002 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4003 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4004 latency environments.
4005
4006
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004007option http-pretend-keepalive
4008no option http-pretend-keepalive
4009 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4011 yes | yes | yes | yes
4012 Arguments : none
4013
4014 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4015 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4016 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4017 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4018 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4019 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4020 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4021 consider the response complete.
4022
4023 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4024 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4025 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4026 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4027 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4028 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4029
4030 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4031 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4032 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4033 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4034 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4035 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4036 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4037
4038 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4039 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004040 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004041 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4042 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004043
4044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4046
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004047 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4048 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004049
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004050
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004051option http-server-close
4052no option http-server-close
4053 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4055 yes | yes | yes | yes
4056 Arguments : none
4057
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004058 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4059 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4060 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4061 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4062 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4063 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4064 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4065 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4066 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4067 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4068 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4069 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4070 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4071 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4072 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4073 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004074
4075 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4076 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4077 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4078 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004079 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4080 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004081
4082 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4083 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004084 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4085 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004086 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4087 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004088
4089 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4090 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4091
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004092 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004093 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4094 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004095
4096
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004097option http-tunnel
4098no option http-tunnel
4099 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4101 yes | yes | yes | yes
4102 Arguments : none
4103
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004104 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4105 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4106 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4107 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4108 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4109 "option http-tunnel".
4110
4111 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004112 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004113 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4114 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4115 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4116 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4117 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4118 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4119 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004120
4121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4123
4124 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4125 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4126 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4127
4128
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004129option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004130no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004131 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4133 yes | yes | yes | no
4134 Arguments : none
4135
4136 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4137 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4138 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4139 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4140 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4141 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4142 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4143
4144 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4145 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4146 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4147 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4148 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4149 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4150 request along its whole life.
4151
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004152 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4153 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4154 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4155 front of an existing proxy.
4156
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004157 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4158
4159 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4160 http-server-close".
4161
4162
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004163option httpchk
4164option httpchk <uri>
4165option httpchk <method> <uri>
4166option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4167 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4169 yes | no | yes | yes
4170 Arguments :
4171 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4172 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4173 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4174 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4175 ones.
4176
4177 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4178 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4179 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4180
4181 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4182 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4183 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4184 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4185 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4186
4187 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4188 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4189 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4190 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4191 the lack of any response.
4192
4193 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4194
4195 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4196 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4197 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4198
4199 Examples :
4200 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4201 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4202 backend https_relay
4203 mode tcp
4204 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4205 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4206
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004207 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4208 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4209 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004210
4211
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004212option httpclose
4213no option httpclose
4214 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4216 yes | yes | yes | yes
4217 Arguments : none
4218
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004219 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4220 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4221 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4222 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004223 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004224 "option http-tunnel".
4225
4226 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4227 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4228 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4229 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4230 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4231 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4232 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4233 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004234
4235 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004236 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004237 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4238 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4239 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4240 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4241 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004242
4243 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4244 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004245 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4246 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004247 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4248 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004249
4250 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4251 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4252
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004253 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4254 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004255
4256
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004257option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004258 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4260 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004261 Arguments :
4262 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4263 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4264 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4265 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4266 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004267
4268 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4269 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4270 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4271 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4272 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4273 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4274 ports.
4275
4276 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4277
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4280 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4281 by default.
4282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004283 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004284
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004285
4286option http_proxy
4287no option http_proxy
4288 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4290 yes | yes | yes | yes
4291 Arguments : none
4292
4293 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4294 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4295 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4296 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4297 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4298
4299 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4300 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4301 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4302 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004303 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004304 be analyzed.
4305
4306 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4307 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4308
4309 Example :
4310 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4311 backend direct_forward
4312 option httpclose
4313 option http_proxy
4314
4315 See also : "option httpclose"
4316
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004317
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004318option independent-streams
4319no option independent-streams
4320 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4322 yes | yes | yes | yes
4323 Arguments : none
4324
4325 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4326 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4327 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4328 receive data or not.
4329
4330 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4331 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4332 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4333 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4334 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4335 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4336 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4337 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4338 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4339 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4340 socket buffers.
4341
4342 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4343 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4344 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4345 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4346 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4347
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004348 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004349 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4350 deprecated.
4351
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004352 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004353
4354
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004355option ldap-check
4356 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4358 yes | no | yes | yes
4359 Arguments : none
4360
4361 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4362 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4363 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4364 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4365
4366 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4367 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4368
4369 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4370 configure it.
4371
4372 Example :
4373 option ldap-check
4374
4375 See also : "option httpchk"
4376
4377
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004378option log-health-checks
4379no option log-health-checks
4380 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4382 yes | no | yes | yes
4383 Arguments : none
4384
4385 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4386 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4387 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4388 of additional information is limited.
4389
4390 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4391 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4392
4393 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4394
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004395
4396option log-separate-errors
4397no option log-separate-errors
4398 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4400 yes | yes | yes | no
4401 Arguments : none
4402
4403 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4404 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4405 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4406 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4407 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4408 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4409 provides very important information.
4410
4411 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4412 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4413 error logs.
4414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004415 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004416 logging.
4417
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004418
4419option logasap
4420no option logasap
4421 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4423 yes | yes | yes | no
4424 Arguments : none
4425
4426 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4427 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4428 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4429 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4430 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4431 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4432 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004433 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004434 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4435 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4436
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004437 Examples :
4438 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4439 mode http
4440 option httplog
4441 option logasap
4442 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4443
4444 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4445 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4446 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4447 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004449 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004450 logging.
4451
4452
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004453option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4454 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4456 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004457 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004458 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4459 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004460
4461 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4462 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4463 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4464 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4465 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4466 in the MySQL table, like this :
4467
4468 USE mysql;
4469 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4470 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4471
4472 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4473 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4474 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4475 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4476 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4477 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4478 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4479 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4480 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4481
4482 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4483 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004484
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004485 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004486
4487 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4488 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4489 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4490 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4491 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4492 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4493
4494 See also: "option httpchk"
4495
4496
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004497option nolinger
4498no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004499 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004500 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4501 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004502 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004503
4504 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4505 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4506 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4507 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4508 connections.
4509
4510 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4511 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4512 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4513 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4514 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4515 this too.
4516
4517 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4518 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4519 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4520
4521 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4522 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4523 for servers.
4524
4525 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4526 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4527
4528
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004529option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4530 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4532 yes | yes | yes | yes
4533 Arguments :
4534 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4535 matching <network>
4536 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4537 header name.
4538
4539 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4540 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4541 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4542 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4543 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4544 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4545 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4546 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4547 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4548 possible that the client has already brought one.
4549
4550 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4551 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4552 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4553 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4554 header and requires different one.
4555
4556 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4557 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4558 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4559 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4560 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4561 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4562 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4563
4564 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4565 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4566 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4567 both are defined.
4568
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004569 Examples :
4570 # Original Destination address
4571 frontend www
4572 mode http
4573 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4574
4575 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4576 backend www
4577 mode http
4578 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4579
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004580 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4581 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004582
4583
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004584option persist
4585no option persist
4586 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4587 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4588 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004589 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004590
4591 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4592 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4593 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4594 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4595 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4596 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4597 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4598 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4599 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4600 redirected to another valid server.
4601
4602 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4603 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4604
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004605 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004606
4607
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004608option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4609 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4611 yes | no | yes | yes
4612 Arguments :
4613 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4614 PostgreSQL server.
4615
4616 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4617 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4618 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4619 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4620
4621 See also: "option httpchk"
4622
4623
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004624option prefer-last-server
4625no option prefer-last-server
4626 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4628 yes | no | yes | yes
4629 Arguments : none
4630
4631 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4632 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4633 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4634 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4635 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4636 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4637 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4638 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4639 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004640 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4641 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4642 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4643 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4644 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4645 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4646 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004647
4648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4650
4651 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4652
4653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004654option redispatch
4655no option redispatch
4656 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4658 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004659 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004660
4661 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4662 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4663 be able to access the service anymore.
4664
4665 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4666 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4667
4668 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4669 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4670 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004672 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4673 "redisp" keywords.
4674
4675 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4676 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4677
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004678 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004679
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004680
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004681option redis-check
4682 Use redis health checks for server testing
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 yes | no | yes | yes
4685 Arguments : none
4686
4687 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4688 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4689 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4690 find the "+PONG" response message.
4691
4692 Example :
4693 option redis-check
4694
4695 See also : "option httpchk"
4696
4697
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004698option smtpchk
4699option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4700 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4702 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004703 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004704 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4705 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4706 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4707
4708 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4709 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4710 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4711
4712 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4713 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4714 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4715 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4716 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4717 dead server.
4718
4719 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4720 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4721 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4722 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4723
4724 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4725 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4726 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4727 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4728 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4729
4730 Example :
4731 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4732
4733 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004736option socket-stats
4737no option socket-stats
4738
4739 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | yes | yes | no
4742
4743 Arguments : none
4744
4745
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004746option splice-auto
4747no option splice-auto
4748 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4750 yes | yes | yes | yes
4751 Arguments : none
4752
4753 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4754 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4755 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4756 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004757 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004758 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4759 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4760 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4761 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4762
4763 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4764 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4765 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4766 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4767 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4768 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4769 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4770 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4771 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4772 keyword.
4773
4774 Example :
4775 option splice-auto
4776
4777 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4778 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4779
4780 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4781 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4782
4783
4784option splice-request
4785no option splice-request
4786 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4788 yes | yes | yes | yes
4789 Arguments : none
4790
4791 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004792 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004793 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4794 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4795 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4796 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4797
4798 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4799
4800 Example :
4801 option splice-request
4802
4803 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4804 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4805
4806 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4807 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4808
4809
4810option splice-response
4811no option splice-response
4812 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4814 yes | yes | yes | yes
4815 Arguments : none
4816
4817 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004818 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004819 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4820 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4821 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4822 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4823
4824 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4825
4826 Example :
4827 option splice-response
4828
4829 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4830 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4831
4832 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4833 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4834
4835
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004836option srvtcpka
4837no option srvtcpka
4838 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4840 yes | no | yes | yes
4841 Arguments : none
4842
4843 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4844 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4845 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4846 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4847
4848 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4849 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4850 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4851 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4852
4853 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4854 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4855 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4856 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4857 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4858
4859 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4860
4861 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4862 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4863 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4864
4865 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4866 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4867
4868 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4869
4870
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004871option ssl-hello-chk
4872 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4874 yes | no | yes | yes
4875 Arguments : none
4876
4877 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4878 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4879 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4880 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4881 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4882 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4883 hello message.
4884
4885 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4886 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4887 messages, which is appreciable.
4888
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004889 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4890 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4891 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004892
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004893 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4894
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004895
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004896option tcp-check
4897 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4898 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4899 yes | no | yes | yes
4900
4901 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4902 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4903
4904 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4905 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4906 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4907
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004908 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004909 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4910 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4911 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4912 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4913 only.
4914
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004915 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004916 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4917 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4918 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4919 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4920
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004921 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004922 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4923 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004924 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004925 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4926 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4927 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4928 the respective protocols.
4929 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4930 analysed.
4931
4932 Examples :
4933 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4934 option tcp-check
4935 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4936
4937 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4938 option tcp-check
4939 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4940
4941 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4942 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004943 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004944 option tcp-check
4945 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4946 tcp-check expect +PONG
4947 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4948 tcp-check expect string role:master
4949 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4950 tcp-check expect string +OK
4951
4952 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4953 (send many headers before analyzing)
4954 option tcp-check
4955 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4956 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4957 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4958 tcp-check send \r\n
4959 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4960
4961
4962 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4963
4964
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004965option tcp-smart-accept
4966no option tcp-smart-accept
4967 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4969 yes | yes | yes | no
4970 Arguments : none
4971
4972 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4973 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4974 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4975 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4976 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4977 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4978
4979 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4980 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4981 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4982 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4983
4984 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4985 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4986 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4987 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4988
4989 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4990 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4991 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4992
4993 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4994 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4995 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4996
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004997 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4998
4999
5000option tcp-smart-connect
5001no option tcp-smart-connect
5002 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5004 yes | no | yes | yes
5005 Arguments : none
5006
5007 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5008 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5009 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5010 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5011 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5012
5013 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5014 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5015 complex.
5016
5017 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5018 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5019 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5020
5021 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5022 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5023
5024 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5025
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005026
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005027option tcpka
5028 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5030 yes | yes | yes | yes
5031 Arguments : none
5032
5033 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5034 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5035 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5036 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5037
5038 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5039 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5040 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5041 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5042
5043 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5044 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5045 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5046 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5047 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5048
5049 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5050
5051 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5052 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5053 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5054 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5055 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5056 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5057 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5058 backends.
5059
5060 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5061
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005062
5063option tcplog
5064 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5066 yes | yes | yes | yes
5067 Arguments : none
5068
5069 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5070 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5071 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5072 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5073 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5074 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5075 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5076 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5077
5078 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005080 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005081
5082
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005083option transparent
5084no option transparent
5085 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005087 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005088 Arguments : none
5089
5090 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5091 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5092 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5093 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5094 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5095 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5096 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5097 appropriate server.
5098
5099 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5100 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5101
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005102 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005103 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005104
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005105
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005106persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005107persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005108 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5110 yes | no | yes | yes
5111 Arguments :
5112 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005113 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5114 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005115
5116 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5117 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5118 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5119 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5120 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5121 forwarded to this server.
5122
5123 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5124 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5125 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005126 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005127 a single "listen" section.
5128
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005129 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5130 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5131 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5132
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005133 Example :
5134 listen tse-farm
5135 bind :3389
5136 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5137 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5138 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5139 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5140 persist rdp-cookie
5141 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005142 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005143 balance rdp-cookie
5144 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5145 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5146
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005147 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5148 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005149
5150
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005151rate-limit sessions <rate>
5152 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5154 yes | yes | yes | no
5155 Arguments :
5156 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5157 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5158
5159 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5160 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5161 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5162 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5163 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5164 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5165
5166 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5167 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5168 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5169 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5170
5171 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5172 listen smtp
5173 mode tcp
5174 bind :25
5175 rate-limit sessions 10
5176 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5177
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005178 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5179 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5180 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005181
5182 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5183
5184
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005185redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5186redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5187redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005188 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5190 no | yes | yes | yes
5191
5192 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005193 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005194
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005195 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005196 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005197 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5198 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5199 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005200
5201 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5202 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5203 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5204 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5205 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005206 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5207 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5208 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5209 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005210
5211 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5212 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5213 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5214 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5215 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5216 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005217 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005218 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005219 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5220 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5221 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005222
5223 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005224 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5225 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5226 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5227 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5228 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5229 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5230 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5231 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005232
5233 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5234 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5235
5236 - "drop-query"
5237 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5238 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5239 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5240 with a location-type redirect.
5241
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005242 - "append-slash"
5243 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5244 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5245 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5246 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5247
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005248 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5249 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5250 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5251 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5252 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5253 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5254 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5255
5256 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5257 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5258 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5259 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5260 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5261 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5262 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005263
5264 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5265 acl clear dst_port 80
5266 acl secure dst_port 8080
5267 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005268 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005269 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005270 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5271
5272 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005273 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5274 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5275 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005276 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005277
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005278 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5279 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5280 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5281
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005282 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005283 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005284
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005285 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5286 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5287 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005289 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005290
5291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005292redisp (deprecated)
5293redispatch (deprecated)
5294 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5295 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005297 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005298
5299 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5300 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5301 be able to access the service anymore.
5302
5303 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5304 redistribute them to a working server.
5305
5306 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5307 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5308 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005310 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5311 "option redispatch" instead.
5312
5313 See also : "option redispatch"
5314
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005315
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005316reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005317 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5319 no | yes | yes | yes
5320 Arguments :
5321 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5322 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005323 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005324
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005325 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5326 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5327
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005328 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5329 the last header of an HTTP request.
5330
5331 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5332 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5333 responses.
5334
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005335 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5336 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5337 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5338
5339 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5340 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005341
5342
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005343reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5344reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005345 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5347 no | yes | yes | yes
5348 Arguments :
5349 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5350 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5351 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5352 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5353 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5354 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5355 ignores case.
5356
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005357 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5358 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5359
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005360 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5361 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5362 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5363 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005364 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005365
5366 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5367 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5368
5369 Example :
5370 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5371 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5372 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5373
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005374 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5375 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005376
5377
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005378reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5379reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005380 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5382 no | yes | yes | yes
5383 Arguments :
5384 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5385 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5386 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5387 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5388 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5389 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5390
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005391 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5392 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5393
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005394 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5395 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5396 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5397 next servers.
5398
5399 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5400 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5401 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5402
5403 Example :
5404 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5405 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5406 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5407
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005408 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5409 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005410
5411
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005412reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5413reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005414 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5416 no | yes | yes | yes
5417 Arguments :
5418 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5419 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5420 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5421 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5422 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5423 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5424 case.
5425
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005426 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5427 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5428
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005429 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5430 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5431 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5432 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005433 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005434
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005435 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005436 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005437 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005438
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005439 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5440 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5441
5442 Example :
5443 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5444 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5445 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5446
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005447 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5448 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005449
5450
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005451reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5452reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005453 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 no | yes | yes | yes
5456 Arguments :
5457 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5458 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5459 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5460 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5461 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5462 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5463 case.
5464
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005465 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5466 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5467
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005468 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5469 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5470 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5471 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5472
5473 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5474 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5475
5476 Example :
5477 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5478 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5479 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5480 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5481
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005482 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5483 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005484
5485
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005486reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5487reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005488 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5490 no | yes | yes | yes
5491 Arguments :
5492 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5493 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5494 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5495 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5496 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5497 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5498
5499 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5500 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5501 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5502 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005503 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005504
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005505 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5506 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5507
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005508 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5509 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5510 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5511
5512 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5513 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5514 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5515 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5516 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5517
5518 Example :
5519 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005520 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005521 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5522 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5523
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005524 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5525 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005526
5527
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005528reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5529reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005530 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5532 no | yes | yes | yes
5533 Arguments :
5534 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5535 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5536 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5537 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5538 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5539 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5540 ignores case.
5541
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005542 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5543 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5544
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005545 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5546 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005547 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5548 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5549 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005550 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5551 not set.
5552
5553 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5554 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5555 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5556 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5557 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5558
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005559 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005560 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5561 # block all others.
5562 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5563 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5564
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005565 # block bad guys
5566 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5567 reqitarpit . if badguys
5568
5569 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5570 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005571
5572
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005573retries <value>
5574 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5575 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5576 yes | no | yes | yes
5577 Arguments :
5578 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5579 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5580 default value is 3.
5581
5582 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5583 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5584 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5585
5586 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5587 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5588
5589 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5590 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5591
5592 See also : "option redispatch"
5593
5594
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005595rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005596 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5598 no | yes | yes | yes
5599 Arguments :
5600 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5601 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005602 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005603
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005604 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5605 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5606
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005607 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5608 the last header of an HTTP response.
5609
5610 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5611 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5612 responses.
5613
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005614 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5615 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005616
5617
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005618rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5619rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005620 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5622 no | yes | yes | yes
5623 Arguments :
5624 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5625 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5626 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5627 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5628 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5629 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5630 ignores case.
5631
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005632 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5633 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5634
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005635 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5636 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005637 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005638 client.
5639
5640 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5641 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5642 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5643
5644 Example :
5645 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005646 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005647
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005648 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5649 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005650
5651
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005652rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5653rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005654 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5656 no | yes | yes | yes
5657 Arguments :
5658 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5659 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5660 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5661 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5662 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5663 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5664 ignores case.
5665
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005666 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5667 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5668
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005669 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5670 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5671 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5672 case-sensitive.
5673
5674 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005675 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5676 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5677 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005678
5679 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5680 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5681
5682 Example :
5683 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5684 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5685
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005686 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5687 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005688
5689
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005690rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5691rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005692 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5694 no | yes | yes | yes
5695 Arguments :
5696 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5697 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5698 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5699 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5700 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5701 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5702 ignores case.
5703
5704 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5705 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5706 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5707 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005708 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005709
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005710 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5711 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5712
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005713 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5714 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5715 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5716
5717 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5718 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5719 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5720 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5721 are not case-sensitive.
5722
5723 Example :
5724 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5725 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5726
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005727 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5728 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005729
5730
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005731server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005732 Declare a server in a backend
5733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5734 no | no | yes | yes
5735 Arguments :
5736 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005737 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005738 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005739
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005740 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5741 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5742 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5743 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005744 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5745 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5746 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5747 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5748 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005749 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5750 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5751 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5752 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5753 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5754 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5755 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005756 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005757 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5758 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5759 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5760 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005761
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005762 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005763 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5764 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5765 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5766 adding this value to the client's port.
5767
5768 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5769 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005770 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005771
5772 Examples :
5773 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5774 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005775 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005776 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5777 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5778 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005779
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005780 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5781 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005782
5783
5784source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005785source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005786source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005787 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5789 yes | no | yes | yes
5790 Arguments :
5791 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5792 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005793
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005794 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005795 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5796 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5797 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5798 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5799 supported prefixes are :
5800 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5801 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5802 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005803 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005804 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5805 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5806 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5807 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005808
5809 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5810 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005811 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5812 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5813 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005814
5815 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5816 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5817 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5818 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5819 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5820 <addr>.
5821
5822 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5823 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5824 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5825 port.
5826
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005827 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5828 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5829 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5830 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005831 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005832 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5833 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5834 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5835 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5836 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5837 HTTP header.
5838
5839 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5840 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005841 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005842 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5843 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5844 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5845 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5846 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5847 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5848 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5849
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005850 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5851 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5852 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5853 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5854 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5855 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5856
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005857 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5858 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5859 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5860 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5861
5862 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5863 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5864 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5865 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5866 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5867 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5868
5869 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5870 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5871 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5872 there are two methods :
5873
5874 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5875 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5876 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5877 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5878 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5879 of the client ranges may be used.
5880
5881 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5882 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5883 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5884 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5885 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5886 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5887 same session.
5888
5889 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5890 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5891 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5892 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5893 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5894 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5895
5896 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5897 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5898 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005899 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005900
5901 Examples :
5902 backend private
5903 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5904 source 192.168.1.200
5905
5906 backend transparent_ssl1
5907 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5908 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5909
5910 backend transparent_ssl2
5911 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5912 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5913 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5914
5915 backend transparent_ssl3
5916 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5917 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5918 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5919
5920 backend transparent_smtp
5921 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5922 # with Tproxy version 4.
5923 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5924
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005925 backend transparent_http
5926 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5927 # proxy.
5928 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005930 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005931 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005933
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005934srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5935 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5937 yes | no | yes | yes
5938 Arguments :
5939 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5940 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5941 as explained at the top of this document.
5942
5943 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5944 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5945 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5946 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5947 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5948 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5949 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5950
5951 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5952 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5953 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5954 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5955 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005956 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005957 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005958 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005959
5960 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5961 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5962 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5963 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5964 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5965 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5966
5967 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5968 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5969
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005970 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5971 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005972
5973
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005974stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5975 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005977 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005978
5979 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5980 matched.
5981
5982 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5983 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5984
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005985 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5986 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5987 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5988
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005989 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5990 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5991 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5992 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005993
5994 Example :
5995 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5996 backend stats_localhost
5997 stats enable
5998 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5999
6000 Example :
6001 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6002 backend stats_auth
6003 stats enable
6004 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6005 stats admin if TRUE
6006
6007 Example :
6008 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6009 userlist stats-auth
6010 group admin users admin
6011 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6012 group readonly users haproxy
6013 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6014
6015 backend stats_auth
6016 stats enable
6017 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6018 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6019 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6020 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6021
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006022 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6023 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6024 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006025
6026
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006027stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6028 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006030 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006031 Arguments :
6032 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6033
6034 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6035
6036 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6037 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6038 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6039 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6040 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6041 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6042
6043 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6044 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6045 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006046 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006047
6048 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6049 report using "stats scope".
6050
6051 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6052 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6053 unobvious parameters.
6054
6055 Example :
6056 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6057 backend public_www
6058 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6059 stats enable
6060 stats hide-version
6061 stats scope .
6062 stats uri /admin?stats
6063 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6064 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6065 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6066
6067 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6068 backend private_monitoring
6069 stats enable
6070 stats uri /admin?stats
6071 stats refresh 5s
6072
6073 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6074
6075
6076stats enable
6077 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006079 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006080 Arguments : none
6081
6082 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6083 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6084 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6085 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6086 - stats auth : no authentication
6087 - stats scope : no restriction
6088
6089 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6090 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6091 unobvious parameters.
6092
6093 Example :
6094 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6095 backend public_www
6096 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6097 stats enable
6098 stats hide-version
6099 stats scope .
6100 stats uri /admin?stats
6101 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6102 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6103 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6104
6105 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6106 backend private_monitoring
6107 stats enable
6108 stats uri /admin?stats
6109 stats refresh 5s
6110
6111 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6112
6113
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006114stats hide-version
6115 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006117 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006118 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006119
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006120 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6121 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6122 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6123 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6124 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6125 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006127 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6128 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6129 unobvious parameters.
6130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006131 Example :
6132 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6133 backend public_www
6134 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006135 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006136 stats hide-version
6137 stats scope .
6138 stats uri /admin?stats
6139 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6140 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6141 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006142
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006143 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6144 backend private_monitoring
6145 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006146 stats uri /admin?stats
6147 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006148
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006149 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006150
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006151
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006152stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6153 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6154 Access control for statistics
6155
6156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6157 no | no | yes | yes
6158
6159 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6160 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6161 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6162 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6163 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6164 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6165
6166 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6167 instance.
6168
6169 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6170 about ACL usage.
6171
6172
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006173stats realm <realm>
6174 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006176 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006177 Arguments :
6178 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6179 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6180 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6181
6182 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6183 using a backslash ('\').
6184
6185 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6186 only related to authentication.
6187
6188 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6189 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6190 unobvious parameters.
6191
6192 Example :
6193 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6194 backend public_www
6195 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6196 stats enable
6197 stats hide-version
6198 stats scope .
6199 stats uri /admin?stats
6200 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6201 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6202 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6203
6204 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6205 backend private_monitoring
6206 stats enable
6207 stats uri /admin?stats
6208 stats refresh 5s
6209
6210 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6211
6212
6213stats refresh <delay>
6214 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006216 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006217 Arguments :
6218 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6219 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6220 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6221 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6222 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6223 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6224
6225 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6226 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6227 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6228 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6229
6230 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6231 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6232 unobvious parameters.
6233
6234 Example :
6235 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6236 backend public_www
6237 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6238 stats enable
6239 stats hide-version
6240 stats scope .
6241 stats uri /admin?stats
6242 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6243 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6244 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6245
6246 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6247 backend private_monitoring
6248 stats enable
6249 stats uri /admin?stats
6250 stats refresh 5s
6251
6252 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6253
6254
6255stats scope { <name> | "." }
6256 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006258 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006259 Arguments :
6260 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6261 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6262 section in which the statement appears.
6263
6264 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6265 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6266 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6267 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6268 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6269 exists.
6270
6271 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6272 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6273 unobvious parameters.
6274
6275 Example :
6276 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6277 backend public_www
6278 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6279 stats enable
6280 stats hide-version
6281 stats scope .
6282 stats uri /admin?stats
6283 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6284 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6285 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6286
6287 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6288 backend private_monitoring
6289 stats enable
6290 stats uri /admin?stats
6291 stats refresh 5s
6292
6293 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6294
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006295
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006296stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006297 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006299 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006300
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006301 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006302 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6303
6304 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6305 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6306
6307 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6308 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006309 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006310
6311 Example :
6312 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6313 backend private_monitoring
6314 stats enable
6315 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6316 stats uri /admin?stats
6317 stats refresh 5s
6318
6319 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6320 global section.
6321
6322
6323stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006324 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6326 yes | yes | yes | yes
6327 Arguments : none
6328
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006329 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006330 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6331 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6332 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6333 - IP (socket, server)
6334 - cookie (backend, server)
6335
6336 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6337 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006338 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006339
6340 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6341
6342
6343stats show-node [ <name> ]
6344 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006346 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006347 Arguments:
6348 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6349 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6350
6351 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6352 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006353 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006354
6355 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6356 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6357 unobvious parameters.
6358
6359 Example:
6360 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6361 backend private_monitoring
6362 stats enable
6363 stats show-node Europe-1
6364 stats uri /admin?stats
6365 stats refresh 5s
6366
6367 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6368 section.
6369
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006370
6371stats uri <prefix>
6372 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006374 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006375 Arguments :
6376 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6377 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6378 query string.
6379
6380 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6381 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6382 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6383 possible to reach it in the application.
6384
6385 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006386 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006387 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6388 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6389 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6390 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6391
6392 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6393 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6394 an address or a port to statistics only.
6395
6396 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6397 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6398 unobvious parameters.
6399
6400 Example :
6401 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6402 backend public_www
6403 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6404 stats enable
6405 stats hide-version
6406 stats scope .
6407 stats uri /admin?stats
6408 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6409 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6410 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6411
6412 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6413 backend private_monitoring
6414 stats enable
6415 stats uri /admin?stats
6416 stats refresh 5s
6417
6418 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6419
6420
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006421stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6422 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006424 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006425
6426 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006427 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006428 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6429 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6430 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6431
6432 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6433 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6434 the "stick-table" statement.
6435
6436 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6437 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6438 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6439 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6440 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6441
6442 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6443 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6444 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6445 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6446 transformation rules.
6447
6448 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6449 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6450 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6451 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6452 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6453 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6454 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6455
6456 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6457 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6458 ACL based conditions.
6459
6460 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6461 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6462 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6463 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6464
6465 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6466 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6467 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6468 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6469
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006470 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6471 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6472 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6473
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006474 Example :
6475 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6476 # last 30 minutes
6477 backend pop
6478 mode tcp
6479 balance roundrobin
6480 stick store-request src
6481 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6482 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6483 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6484
6485 backend smtp
6486 mode tcp
6487 balance roundrobin
6488 stick match src table pop
6489 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6490 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6491
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006492 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6493 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006494
6495
6496stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6497 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6499 no | no | yes | yes
6500
6501 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6502 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6503 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6504 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6505
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006506 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6507 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6508 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6509
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006510 Examples :
6511 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006512 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006513
6514 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6515 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6516 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6517
6518
6519 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6520 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6521 backend http
6522 mode http
6523 balance roundrobin
6524 stick on src table https
6525 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6526 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6527 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6528
6529 backend https
6530 mode tcp
6531 balance roundrobin
6532 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6533 stick on src
6534 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6535 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6536
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006537 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006538
6539
6540stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6541 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6543 no | no | yes | yes
6544
6545 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006546 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006547 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6548 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6549 server is selected.
6550
6551 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6552 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6553 the "stick-table" statement.
6554
6555 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6556 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6557 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6558 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6559 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6560 address.
6561
6562 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6563 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6564 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6565 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6566 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6567 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6568 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6569 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6570 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6571 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6572
6573 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6574 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6575 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6576 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6577 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6578 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6579 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6580
6581 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6582 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6583 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6584 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6585
6586 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6587 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6588 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6589 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6590 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6591 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006592 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6593 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6594 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6595 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6596 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6597 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006598
6599 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6600 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6601 the request.
6602
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006603 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6604 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6605 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6606
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006607 Example :
6608 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6609 # last 30 minutes
6610 backend pop
6611 mode tcp
6612 balance roundrobin
6613 stick store-request src
6614 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6615 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6616 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6617
6618 backend smtp
6619 mode tcp
6620 balance roundrobin
6621 stick match src table pop
6622 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6623 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6624
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006625 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6626 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006627
6628
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006629stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006630 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6631 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006632 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006634 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006635
6636 Arguments :
6637 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6638 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6639 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6640 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6641
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006642 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6643 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6644 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6645 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6646
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006647 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6648 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6649 instance.
6650
6651 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6652 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6653 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6654 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6655 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6656 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006657 to 32 characters.
6658
6659 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6660 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6661 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6662 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6663 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6664 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006665
6666 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006667 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6668 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006669 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6670 increase.
6671
6672 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006673 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6674 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6675 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006676
6677 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6678 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6679 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6680 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6681 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6682 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6683 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6684 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6685 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6686 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6687 parameter (see below).
6688
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006689 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6690 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6691 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6692 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6693 soft restart.
6694
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006695 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6696
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006697 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6698 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6699 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6700 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6701 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006702 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006703 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6704 if not expiration delay is specified.
6705
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006706 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6707 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6708 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6709 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006710 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6711 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6712 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6713 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6714 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6715 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6716 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6717 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6718 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6719 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6720 types and their arguments.
6721
6722 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6723 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6724 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6725 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6726
6727 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6728 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6729 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6730 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6731
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006732 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6733 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6734 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6735 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6736 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6737 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6738
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006739 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6740 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6741 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6742 they were received.
6743
6744 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6745 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6746 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6747 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6748 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6749
6750 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6751 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6752 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6753 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6754 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6755
6756 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6757 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6758 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6759
6760 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6761 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6762 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6763 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6764 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6765
6766 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6767 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6768 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6769 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6770 the client side.
6771
6772 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6773 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6774 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6775 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6776 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6777 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6778 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6779
6780 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6781 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6782 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6783 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6784 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6785 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6786 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6787
6788 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6789 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6790 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6791 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6792 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6793 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6794
6795 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6796 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6797 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6798 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6799
6800 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6801 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6802 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6803 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6804 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6805 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6806 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6807 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6808 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6809 recommended for better fairness.
6810
6811 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6812 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6813 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6814 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6815
6816 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6817 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6818 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6819 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6820 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6821 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6822 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6823 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6824 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6825 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006826
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006827 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6828 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006829 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6830 reference it.
6831
6832 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6833 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6834 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6835 as an exclusive stickiness.
6836
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006837 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6838 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6839 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6840 something that can be ignored.
6841
6842 Example:
6843 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6844 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6845 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6846 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6847
6848 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006849 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006850
6851
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006852stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6853 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6855 no | no | yes | yes
6856
6857 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006858 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006859 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6860 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6861 server is selected.
6862
6863 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6864 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6865 the "stick-table" statement.
6866
6867 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6868 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6869 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6870 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6871
6872 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6873 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6874 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6875 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6876 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6877 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006878 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006879 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6880 rules.
6881
6882 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6883 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6884 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6885 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6886 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6887 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6888 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6889
6890 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6891 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6892 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6893 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6894
6895 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6896 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6897 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6898 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6899 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6900 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006901 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6902 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6903 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6904 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6905 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6906 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6907 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6908 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6909 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006910
6911 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6912
6913 Example :
6914 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6915 backend https
6916 mode tcp
6917 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006918 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006919 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006920
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006921 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6922 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6923
6924 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6925 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6926 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6927
6928 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6929 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006930
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006931 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6932 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6933 # at offset 44.
6934
6935 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6936 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6937
6938 # Learn on response if server hello.
6939 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006940
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006941 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6942 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6943
6944 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6945 extraction.
6946
6947
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02006948tcp-check connect [params*]
6949 Opens a new connection
6950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6951 no | no | yes | yes
6952
6953 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
6954 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
6955 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
6956
6957 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6958 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
6959 of the sequence.
6960
6961 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6962 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6963 do.
6964
6965 Parameters :
6966 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
6967 use the TCP connection.
6968
6969 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
6970 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6971 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
6972
6973 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6974
6975 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6976
6977 Examples:
6978 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6979 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6980 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6981 option tcp-check
6982 tcp-check connect
6983 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6984 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6985 tcp-check send \r\n
6986 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6987 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
6988 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6989 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6990 tcp-check send \r\n
6991 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6992 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6993
6994 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
6995 option tcp-check
6996 tcp-check connect port 110
6997 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
6998 tcp-check connect port 143
6999 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7000 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7001
7002 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7003
7004
7005tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7006 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7008 no | no | yes | yes
7009
7010 Arguments :
7011 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7012 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7013 binary.
7014 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7015 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7016 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7017
7018 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7019 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7020 with the usual backslash ('\').
7021 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7022 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7023 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7024 used upper or lower case.
7025
7026
7027 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7028
7029 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7030 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7031 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7032 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7033 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7034 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7035 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7036 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7037
7038 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7039 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7040 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7041 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7042 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7043 expression.
7044
7045 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7046 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7047 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7048 this exact hexadecimal string.
7049 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7050
7051 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7052 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7053 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7054 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7055 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7056 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7057 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7058 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7059 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7060 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7061 the null character.
7062
7063 Examples :
7064 # perform a POP check
7065 option tcp-check
7066 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7067
7068 # perform an IMAP check
7069 option tcp-check
7070 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7071
7072 # look for the redis master server
7073 option tcp-check
7074 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7075 tcp-check expect +PONG
7076 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7077 tcp-check expect string role:master
7078 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7079 tcp-check expect string +OK
7080
7081
7082 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7083 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7084
7085
7086tcp-check send <data>
7087 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7088 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7089 no | no | yes | yes
7090
7091 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7092 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7093
7094 Examples :
7095 # look for the redis master server
7096 option tcp-check
7097 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7098 tcp-check expect string role:master
7099
7100 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7101 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7102
7103
7104tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7105 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7106 tcp health check
7107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7108 no | no | yes | yes
7109
7110 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7111 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7112 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7113 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7114 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7115 hexadecimal string.
7116 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7117
7118 Examples :
7119 # redis check in binary
7120 option tcp-check
7121 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7122 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7123
7124
7125 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7126 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7127
7128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007129tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7130 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7132 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007133 Arguments :
7134 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007135 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7136 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007138 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007139
7140 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7141 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007142 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7143 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7144 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7145 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7146 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7147 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007149 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7150 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7151 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7152 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007153
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007154 Three types of actions are supported :
7155 - accept :
7156 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7157 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7158 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007159
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007160 - reject :
7161 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7162 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7163 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7164 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7165 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7166 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7167 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7168 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7169 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7170 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7171 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7172 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007173
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007174 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7175 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7176 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7177 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7178 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7179 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7180 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7181 hosts.
7182
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007183 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007184 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7185 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7186 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007187 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7188 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007189 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007190 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7191 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7192 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7193 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7194 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007195
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007196 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007197 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007198 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007199 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7200 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7201 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7202 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007203
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007204 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7205 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7206 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7207 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007208
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007209 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7210 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7211 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7212 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7213 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007214 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7215 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7216 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7217 layer7 information is extracted.
7218
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007219 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7220 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7221 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7222 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7223 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007224
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007225 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7226 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7227 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007228
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007229 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7230 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7231 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007232
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007233 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007234 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007235 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007236
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007237 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7238 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7239 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007240
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007241 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007242 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7243 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007244
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007245 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7246
7247 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7248
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007249 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7250
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007251 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007252
7253
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007254tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7255 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007257 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007258 Arguments :
7259 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007260 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7261 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007262 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007263
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007264 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007266 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7267 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7268 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7269 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7270 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007271
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007272 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7273 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7274 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7275 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007276 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7277 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7278 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7279 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7280 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7281 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007282 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007283 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007284
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007285 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7286 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7287 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7288 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007289
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007290 Three types of actions are supported :
7291 - accept :
7292 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007293 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007294
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007295 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7296 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007297
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007298 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7299 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7300 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7301 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7302 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7303 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007304
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007305 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007306 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7307 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007308
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007309 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007310 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7311 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7312 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7313 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007314 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7315 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7316 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007317
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007318 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7319 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7320 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7321 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7322
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007323 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007324 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7325 # and reject everything else.
7326 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7327 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007328 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007329 tcp-request content reject
7330
7331 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007332 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7333 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7334 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007335 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007336
7337 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7338 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7339 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007340 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007341 tcp-request content reject
7342
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007343 Example:
7344 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7345 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007346 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007347
7348 Example:
7349 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7350 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007351 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007352
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007353 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7354 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7355
7356 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007357 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007358 # protecting all our sites
7359 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007360 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7361 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007362 ...
7363 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7364
7365 backend http_dynamic
7366 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007367 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007368 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007369 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7370 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7371 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007372 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007374 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007375
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007376 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007377
7378
7379tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7380 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007382 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007383 Arguments :
7384 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7385 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7386 as explained at the top of this document.
7387
7388 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7389 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7390 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7391 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7392 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7393
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007394 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7395 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7396 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7397 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7398
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007399 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7400 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007401 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007402 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007403 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7404 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7405 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7406 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007407
7408 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7409 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7410 it pass through unaffected.
7411
7412 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7413 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7414 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007415 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007416 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7417 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007418 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7419 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7420 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007421
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007422 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007423 "timeout client".
7424
7425
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007426tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7427 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7429 no | no | yes | yes
7430 Arguments :
7431 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007432 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007433
7434 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7435
7436 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7437 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7438 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007439 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7440 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007441
7442 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7443
7444 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7445 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7446 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7447 inserted.
7448
7449 Two types of actions are supported :
7450 - accept :
7451 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7452 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7453 the rules evaluation.
7454
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007455 - close :
7456 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7457 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7458 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7459 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7460 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7461 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007462 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007463 protocols.
7464
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007465 - reject :
7466 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7467 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007468 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007469
7470 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7471 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7472 for changing the default action to a reject.
7473
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007474 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7475 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7476 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7477 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007478 period.
7479
7480 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7481
7482 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7483
7484
7485tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7486 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7488 no | no | yes | yes
7489 Arguments :
7490 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7491 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7492 as explained at the top of this document.
7493
7494 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7495
7496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007497timeout check <timeout>
7498 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7499 established.
7500
7501 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7502 yes | no | yes | yes
7503 Arguments:
7504 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7505 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7506 as explained at the top of this document.
7507
7508 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7509 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7510 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7511 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007512 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7513 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7514 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007515
7516 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7517 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7518
7519 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7520 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007521 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007522
7523 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7524 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7525 forget about it.
7526
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007527 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7528 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007529
7530
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007531timeout client <timeout>
7532timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7533 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7535 yes | yes | yes | no
7536 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007537 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007538 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7539 as explained at the top of this document.
7540
7541 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7542 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7543 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7544 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7545 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7546 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7547 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7548 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007549 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007550 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007551 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7552 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007553 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7554 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007555
7556 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7557 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7558 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7559 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7560 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7561 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7562
7563 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7564 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7565 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7566
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007567 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007568
7569
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007570timeout client-fin <timeout>
7571 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7573 yes | yes | yes | no
7574 Arguments :
7575 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7576 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7577 as explained at the top of this document.
7578
7579 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7580 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7581 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7582 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7583 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7584 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7585 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7586 down in one direction.
7587
7588 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7589 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7590 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7591
7592 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7593
7594
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007595timeout connect <timeout>
7596timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7597 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 yes | no | yes | yes
7600 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007601 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007602 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7603 as explained at the top of this document.
7604
7605 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007606 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007607 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007608 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007609 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7610 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007611
7612 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7613 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7614 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7615 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7616 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7617 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7618
7619 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7620 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7621 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7622
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007623 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7624 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007625
7626
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007627timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7628 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7630 yes | yes | yes | yes
7631 Arguments :
7632 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7633 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7634 as explained at the top of this document.
7635
7636 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7637 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7638 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7639 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7640 once the request has started to present itself.
7641
7642 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7643 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7644 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7645 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7646 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7647
7648 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7649 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7650 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7651 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7652
7653 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7654 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7655 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7656 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7657 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007658 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007659
7660 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7661 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7662 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7663 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7664
7665 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7666
7667
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007668timeout http-request <timeout>
7669 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007671 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007672 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007673 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007674 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7675 as explained at the top of this document.
7676
7677 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7678 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7679 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7680 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7681 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7682 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7683 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7684 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7685
7686 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7687 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007688 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7689 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007690
7691 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7692 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7693 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7694 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7695 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7696
7697 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007698 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7699 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7700 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007701
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007702 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007703
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007704
7705timeout queue <timeout>
7706 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7708 yes | no | yes | yes
7709 Arguments :
7710 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7711 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7712 as explained at the top of this document.
7713
7714 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7715 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7716 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7717 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7718 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7719
7720 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7721 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7722 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7723 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7724
7725 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7726
7727
7728timeout server <timeout>
7729timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7730 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7732 yes | no | yes | yes
7733 Arguments :
7734 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7735 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7736 as explained at the top of this document.
7737
7738 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7739 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7740 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7741 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7742 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7743 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7744 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7745
7746 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7747 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7748 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7749 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7750 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007751 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007752 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007753 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7754 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7755 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7756 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007757
7758 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7759 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7760 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7761 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7762 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7763 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7764
7765 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7766 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7767 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7768
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007769 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007770
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007771
7772timeout server-fin <timeout>
7773 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7775 yes | no | yes | yes
7776 Arguments :
7777 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7778 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7779 as explained at the top of this document.
7780
7781 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7782 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7783 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7784 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7785 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7786 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7787 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7788 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7789 situations, it should not be needed.
7790
7791 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7792 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7793 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7794
7795 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7796
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007797
7798timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007799 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7801 yes | yes | yes | yes
7802 Arguments :
7803 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7804 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7805 as explained at the top of this document.
7806
7807 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7808 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7809 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7810
7811 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7812 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7813 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7814 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007815 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007816
7817 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7818
7819
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007820timeout tunnel <timeout>
7821 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7823 yes | no | yes | yes
7824 Arguments :
7825 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7826 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7827 as explained at the top of this document.
7828
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007829 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007830 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7831 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7832 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7833 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7834 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7835 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7836 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7837 specified.
7838
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007839 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
7840 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
7841 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
7842 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
7843 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
7844 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
7845 state.
7846
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007847 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7848 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7849 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7850 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7851 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7852
7853 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7854 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7855 forget about it.
7856
7857 Example :
7858 defaults http
7859 option http-server-close
7860 timeout connect 5s
7861 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007862 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007863 timeout server 30s
7864 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7865
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007866 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007867
7868
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007869transparent (deprecated)
7870 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007872 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007873 Arguments : none
7874
7875 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7876 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7877 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7878 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7879 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7880 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7881 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7882 appropriate server.
7883
7884 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7885
7886 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7887 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7888
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007889 See also: "option transparent"
7890
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007891unique-id-format <string>
7892 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7894 yes | yes | yes | no
7895 Arguments :
7896 <string> is a log-format string.
7897
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007898 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7899 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7900 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7901 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007902
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007903 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7904 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7905 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7906 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7907 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7908 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7909 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7910 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007911
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007912 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7913 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007914
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007915 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007916
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007917 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007918
7919 will generate:
7920
7921 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7922
7923 See also: "unique-id-header"
7924
7925unique-id-header <name>
7926 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7928 yes | yes | yes | no
7929 Arguments :
7930 <name> is the name of the header.
7931
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007932 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7933 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007934
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007935 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007936
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007937 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007938 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7939
7940 will generate:
7941
7942 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7943
7944 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007945
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007946use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007947 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7949 no | yes | yes | no
7950 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007951 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7952 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007953
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007954 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
7955 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007956
7957 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7958 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7959 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007960 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7961 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7962 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7963 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007964
7965 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7966 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7967 assign the backend.
7968
7969 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7970 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7971 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7972 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7973 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7974 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7975
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007976 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007977 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007978 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7979 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7980 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7981
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007982 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7983 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7984 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
7985 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
7986 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
7987 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
7988 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
7989 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
7990 cannot be forced from the request.
7991
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007992 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007993 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
7994 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
7995
7996 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
7997 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007998
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007999
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008000use-server <server> if <condition>
8001use-server <server> unless <condition>
8002 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8004 no | no | yes | yes
8005 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008006 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008007
8008 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8009
8010 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8011 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8012 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8013
8014 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8015 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8016 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8017 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8018 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8019 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8020 matches will assign the server.
8021
8022 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8023 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8024 with the next rules until one matches.
8025
8026 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8027 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8028 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8029 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8030
8031 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8032 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8033 stripped.
8034
8035 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8036 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8037 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8038 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8039
8040 Example :
8041 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8042 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8043 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8044 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8045 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8046 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8047 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8048 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8049 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8050
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008051 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008052
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008053
80545. Bind and Server options
8055--------------------------
8056
8057The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8058depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8059settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8060written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8061described in this section.
8062
8063
80645.1. Bind options
8065-----------------
8066
8067The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8068as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8069no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8070parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8071while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8072provided immediately after the setting name.
8073
8074The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8075
8076accept-proxy
8077 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
8078 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
8079 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8080 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8081 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8082 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8083 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8084 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8085 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008086 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8087 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008088
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008089alpn <protocols>
8090 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8091 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8092 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8093 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8094 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8095 initial NPN extension.
8096
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008097backlog <backlog>
8098 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8099 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8100
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008101ecdhe <named curve>
8102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008103 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8104 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008105
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008106ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008107 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8108 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8109 client's certificate.
8110
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008111ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8113 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8114 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8115 error is ignored.
8116
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008117ciphers <ciphers>
8118 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8119 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008120 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008121 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8122 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8123
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008124crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8126 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8127 to verify client's certificate.
8128
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008129crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008130 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8131 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8132 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8133 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8134 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8135 file.
8136
8137 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8138 are loaded.
8139
8140 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
8141 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
8142 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8143 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8144 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8145 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8146 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8147 www.sub.example.org).
8148
8149 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8150 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8151 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8152 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8153 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8154
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008155 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008156
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008157 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8158 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008159 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008160 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8161 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8162 clients).
8163
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008164crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8166 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008167 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008168 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008169
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008170crt-list <file>
8171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008172 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8173 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008174
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008175 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008176
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008177 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8178 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8179 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8180 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8181 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8182 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8183 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8184 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008185
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008186defer-accept
8187 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8188 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8189 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8190 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8191 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8192 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8193 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8194 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8195 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8196 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8197 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8198
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008199force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008200 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008201 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8202 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8203
8204force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008205 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008206 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8207
8208force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008209 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008210 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8211
8212force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008213 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008214 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8215
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008216gid <gid>
8217 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8218 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8219 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8220 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8221 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8222
8223group <group>
8224 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8225 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8226 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8227 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8228 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8229
8230id <id>
8231 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8232 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8233 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8234 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8235
8236interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008237 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8238 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8239 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8240 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8241 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8242 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8243 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008244
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008245level <level>
8246 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8247 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8248 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8249 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8250 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8251 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8252 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8253 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8254 counters).
8255 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8256 all counters).
8257
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008258maxconn <maxconn>
8259 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8260 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8261 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8262 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8263 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8264 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8265 eat all memory.
8266
8267mode <mode>
8268 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8269 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8270 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8271 UNIX sockets.
8272
8273mss <maxseg>
8274 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8275 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8276 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8277 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8278 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8279 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8280 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8281 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8282 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8283 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8284 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8285
8286name <name>
8287 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8288 page.
8289
8290nice <nice>
8291 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8292 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8293 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8294 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8295 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8296 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8297 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8298 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8299 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8300 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8301 one for an RDP socket.
8302
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008303no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008304 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008305 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008306 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008307 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8308 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008309
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008310no-tls-tickets
8311 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8312 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8313 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8314 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8315
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008316no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008318 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008319 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8320 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8321 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008322
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008323no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008324 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008325 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008326 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8327 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8328 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008329
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008330no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008332 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008333 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8334 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8335 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008336
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008337npn <protocols>
8338 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8339 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8340 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8341 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008342 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8343 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008344
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008345process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8346 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8347 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8348 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8349 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8350 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8351 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8352 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008353 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8354 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8355 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8356 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8357 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8358 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8359 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008360
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008361ssl
8362 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008363 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008364 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8365 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8366 to deciphered contents.
8367
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008368strict-sni
8369 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8370 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8371 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8372 See the "crt" option for more information.
8373
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008374tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008375 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008376 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8377 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8378 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8379 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8380 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8381 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8382 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008383 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8384 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8385 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008386
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008387transparent
8388 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8389 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8390 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8391 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8392 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8393 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8394 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8395 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8396 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8397 so check for support with your vendor.
8398
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008399v4v6
8400 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8401 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8402 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8403 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008404 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008405
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008406v6only
8407 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8408 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8409 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008410 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8411 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008412
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008413uid <uid>
8414 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8415 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8416 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8417 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8418 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8419
8420user <user>
8421 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8422 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8423 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8424 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8425 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8426
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008427verify [none|optional|required]
8428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8429 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8430 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8431 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8432 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008433 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8434 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8435 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8436 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008437
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020084385.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008439------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008440
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008441The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8442which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8443arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8444settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8445after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8446Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8447address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008449 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008450 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008452The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008453
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008454addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008455 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8456 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8457 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8458 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8459 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008461 Supported in default-server: No
8462
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008463agent-check
8464 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8465 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8466 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8467 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8468
8469 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8470 e.g. "75%"
8471
8472 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8473 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8474
8475 * The string "drain".
8476
8477 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8478 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8479 persistence.
8480
8481 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8482
8483 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8484
8485 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8486
8487 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8488
8489 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8490
8491 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8492
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008493 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8494 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8495 parameter.
8496
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008497 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8498 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8499
8500 Supported in default-server: No
8501
8502agent-inter <delay>
8503 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8504 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8505
8506 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8507 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8508 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8509 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8510 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8511 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8512 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8513 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8514 of backends use the same servers.
8515
8516 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8517
8518 Supported in default-server: Yes
8519
8520agent-port <port>
8521 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8522
8523 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8524
8525 Supported in default-server: Yes
8526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008527backup
8528 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8529 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8530 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8531 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8532 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8533 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008535 Supported in default-server: No
8536
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008537ca-file <cafile>
8538 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8539 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8540 server's certificate.
8541
8542 Supported in default-server: No
8543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008544check
8545 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008546 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8547 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8548 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8549 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8550 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8551 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8552 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008553 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8554 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8555 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008556
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008557 Supported in default-server: No
8558
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008559check-send-proxy
8560 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8561 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8562 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8563 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8564 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8565 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8566 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8567
8568 Supported in default-server: No
8569
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008570check-ssl
8571 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8572 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8573 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8574 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008575 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008576 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8577 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8578 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8579 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8580
8581 Supported in default-server: No
8582
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008583ciphers <ciphers>
8584 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008585 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008586 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8587 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8588 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8589 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8590 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8591 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8592
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008593 Supported in default-server: No
8594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008595cookie <value>
8596 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8597 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8598 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8599 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8600 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8601 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8602 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008604 Supported in default-server: No
8605
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008606crl-file <crlfile>
8607 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8608 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8609 to verify server's certificate.
8610
8611 Supported in default-server: No
8612
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008613crt <cert>
8614 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8615 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8616 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8617 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8618 certificate request.
8619
8620 Supported in default-server: No
8621
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008622disabled
8623 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8624 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8625 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8626 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8627 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8628
8629 Supported in default-server: No
8630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008631error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008632 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8633 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8634 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008636 Supported in default-server: Yes
8637
8638 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008639
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008640fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008641 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8642 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8643 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008645 Supported in default-server: Yes
8646
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008647force-sslv3
8648 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8649 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8650 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8651
8652 Supported in default-server: No
8653
8654force-tlsv10
8655 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8656 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8657
8658 Supported in default-server: No
8659
8660force-tlsv11
8661 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8662 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8663
8664 Supported in default-server: No
8665
8666force-tlsv12
8667 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8668 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8669
8670 Supported in default-server: No
8671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008672id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008673 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8674 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8675 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008677 Supported in default-server: No
8678
8679inter <delay>
8680fastinter <delay>
8681downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008682 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8683 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8684 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8685 between checks depending on the server state :
8686
8687 Server state | Interval used
8688 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8689 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8690 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8691 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8692 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8693 or yet unchecked. |
8694 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8695 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8696 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008698 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8699 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8700 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8701 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008702 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8703 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8704 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8705 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8706 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008708 Supported in default-server: Yes
8709
8710maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008711 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8712 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8713 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8714 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8715 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8716 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8717 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8718 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008720 Supported in default-server: Yes
8721
8722maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008723 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8724 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8725 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8726 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8727 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8728 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8729 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008731 Supported in default-server: Yes
8732
8733minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008734 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8735 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8736 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8737 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8738 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8739 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008740 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008741 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008743 Supported in default-server: Yes
8744
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008745no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008746 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8747 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008748 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008749
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008750 Supported in default-server: No
8751
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008752no-tls-tickets
8753 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8754 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8755 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8756 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8757
8758 Supported in default-server: No
8759
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008760no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008761 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008762 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8763 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008764 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8765 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008766
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008767 Supported in default-server: No
8768
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008769no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008770 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008771 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8772 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008773 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8774 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008775
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008776 Supported in default-server: No
8777
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008778no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008779 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008780 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8781 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008782 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8783 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008784
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008785 Supported in default-server: No
8786
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008787non-stick
8788 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8789 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8790 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8791
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008792 Supported in default-server: No
8793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008794observe <mode>
8795 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8796 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8797 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8798 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8799 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8800 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008801 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008802
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008803 Supported in default-server: No
8804
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008805 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8806
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008807on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008808 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8809 Currently, four modes are available:
8810 - fastinter: force fastinter
8811 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8812 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8813 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8814 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008816 Supported in default-server: Yes
8817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008818 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8819
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008820on-marked-down <action>
8821 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8822 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008823 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8824 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8825 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8826 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8827 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8828 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8829 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8830 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008831
8832 Actions are disabled by default
8833
8834 Supported in default-server: Yes
8835
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008836on-marked-up <action>
8837 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8838 Currently one action is available:
8839 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8840 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8841 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8842 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8843 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8844 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8845 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8846 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8847
8848 Actions are disabled by default
8849
8850 Supported in default-server: Yes
8851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008852port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008853 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8854 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8855 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8856 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8857 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8858 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008860 Supported in default-server: Yes
8861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008862redir <prefix>
8863 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8864 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8865 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8866 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8867 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8868 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8869 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8870 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008871 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008872 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8873 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8874 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8875 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8876 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8877
8878 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008880 Supported in default-server: No
8881
8882rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008883 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8884 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8885 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008887 Supported in default-server: Yes
8888
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008889send-proxy
8890 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8891 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8892 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8893 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8894 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8895 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8896 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8897 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8898 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008899 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8900 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8901 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8902 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8903 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008904
8905 Supported in default-server: No
8906
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04008907send-proxy-v2
8908 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
8909 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8910 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8911 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8912 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
8913 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
8914 option of the "bind" keyword.
8915
8916 Supported in default-server: No
8917
8918send-proxy-v2-ssl
8919 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8920 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8921 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8922 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8923 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8924 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
8925 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
8926 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8927
8928 Supported in default-server: No
8929
8930send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
8931 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8932 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8933 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8934 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8935 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8936 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
8937 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
8938 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
8939 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8940
8941 Supported in default-server: No
8942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008943slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008944 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8945 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8946 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8947 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8948 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8949 parameters :
8950
8951 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8952 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8953
8954 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8955 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8956 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8957 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8958
8959 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8960 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8961 seen as failed.
8962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008963 Supported in default-server: Yes
8964
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008965source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008966source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008967source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008968 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8969 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8970 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8971 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8972
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008973 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8974 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8975 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8976 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8977 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8978 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8979 server.
8980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008981 Supported in default-server: No
8982
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008983ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008984 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8985 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8986 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8987 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8988 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8989 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008990 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008991
8992 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008994track [<proxy>/]<server>
8995 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8996 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8997 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8998 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8999 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009001 Supported in default-server: No
9002
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009003verify [none|required]
9004 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009005 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9006 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9007 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9008 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009009 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9010 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9011 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009012
9013 Supported in default-server: No
9014
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009015verifyhost <hostname>
9016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9017 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9018 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9019 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9020 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9021 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9022
9023 Supported in default-server: No
9024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009025weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009026 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9027 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9028 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009029 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9030 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9031 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9032 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9033 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9034 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009036 Supported in default-server: Yes
9037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009038
90396. HTTP header manipulation
9040---------------------------
9041
9042In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9043response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9044request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9045which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009046against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009047
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009048If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9049to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9050but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9051HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9052stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9053because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9054a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9055still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009057This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9058in section 4.2 :
9059
9060 - reqadd <string>
9061 - reqallow <search>
9062 - reqiallow <search>
9063 - reqdel <search>
9064 - reqidel <search>
9065 - reqdeny <search>
9066 - reqideny <search>
9067 - reqpass <search>
9068 - reqipass <search>
9069 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9070 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9071 - reqtarpit <search>
9072 - reqitarpit <search>
9073 - rspadd <string>
9074 - rspdel <search>
9075 - rspidel <search>
9076 - rspdeny <search>
9077 - rspideny <search>
9078 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9079 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9080
9081With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9082is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9083parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9084prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9085Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9086
9087 \t for a tab
9088 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9089 \n for a new line (LF)
9090 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9091 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9092 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9093 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9094 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9095
9096The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9097portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9098above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9099regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
91009 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9101is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9102
9103The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9104after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9105
9106Notes related to these keywords :
9107---------------------------------
9108 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9109 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9110 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9111
9112 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9113 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9114 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9115
9116 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9117 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9118 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9119 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9120 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9121
9122 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9123 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9124 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9125 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9126 useless headers before adding new ones.
9127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009128 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009129 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9130
9131 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9132 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9133 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9134
9135 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9136 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009137 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009138
9139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091407. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9141----------------------------------
9142
9143Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9144client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9145The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9146these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9147but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9148data called patterns.
9149
9150
91517.1. ACL basics
9152---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009153
9154The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9155content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9156from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9157simple :
9158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009159 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009160 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009161 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9162 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009164The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9165adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009166
9167In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009169 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009170
9171This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9172Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9173and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009174an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9175conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9176as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9177are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009178
9179ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9180'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9181which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9182
9183There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9184performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009186The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9187specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9188this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009189methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9190ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009191
9192Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9193 - boolean
9194 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9195 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9196 - string
9197 - data block
9198
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009199Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9200converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9201would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9202The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9203which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009205The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9206 - boolean
9207 - integer or integer range
9208 - IP address / network
9209 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9210 - regular expression
9211 - hex block
9212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009213The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9214
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009215 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9216 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009217 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009218 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009219 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009220 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009221 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009223The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9224read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9225if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9226lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9227will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9228beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9229a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9230lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9231exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9232
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009233The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9234parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9235ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9236a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9237check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9238
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009239The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9240socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9241file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009243Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9244loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9245
9246 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9247
9248In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9249the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9250case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9251as well.
9252
9253The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9254sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9255do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9256methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9257is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9258obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9259followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9260default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9261that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9262string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9263
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009264The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9265By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9266string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9267resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9268server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9269waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9270flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9271function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009273There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9274sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9275be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009276
9277 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9278 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009279 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9280 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9281 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9282 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009283
9284 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9285 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009286 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009287
9288 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009289 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009290
9291 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009292 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009293
9294 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9295 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9296
9297 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9298 binary or string samples.
9299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009300 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9301 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009303 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9304 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9305 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009307 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9308 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009310 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9311 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009313 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9314 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009316 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9317 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009318 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009320 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9321 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9322 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009323
9324For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9325request, it is possible to do :
9326
9327 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9328
9329In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9330buffer, one would use the following acl :
9331
9332 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9333
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009334On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9335possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9336
9337 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009339All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9340criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9341method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9342to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9343criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9344the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009346If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009347the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9348For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009350 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9351 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9352 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9353 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009354
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009355
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009356The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009357and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9358combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
9359the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009361 +-------------------------------------------------+
9362 | Input sample type |
9363 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9364 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
9365 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9366 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9367 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009368 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009369 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009370 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009371 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009372 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009373 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009374 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009375 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009376 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009377 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009378 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009379 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009380 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009381 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009382 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009383 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009384 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009385 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009386 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009387 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009388 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009389 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9390 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9391 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009392
9393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093947.1.1. Matching booleans
9395------------------------
9396
9397In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9398Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9399When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9400that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9401
9402Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9403return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9404"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9405
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094077.1.2. Matching integers
9408------------------------
9409
9410Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9411enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9412to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9413
9414Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9415matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9416lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009417
9418For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9419unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9420representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9421
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009422As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9423two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9424instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9425ranges and operators.
9426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009427For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009428operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9429Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9430of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009432Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009433
9434 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9435 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9436 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9437 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9438 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9439
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009440For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009441
9442 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9443
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009444This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9445
9446 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9447
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094497.1.3. Matching strings
9450-----------------------
9451
9452String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9453different forms :
9454
9455 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9456 patterns ;
9457
9458 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9459 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9460
9461 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9462 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9463
9464 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9465 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9466
9467 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9468 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9469 matches.
9470
9471 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9472 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9473 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009474
9475String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9476exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9477characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9478string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9479to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009480before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009481
9482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094837.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9484---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009485
9486Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9487they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9488possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9489passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9490the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009491the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9492match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009493
9494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094957.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9496-------------------------------------
9497
9498It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9499not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9500a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9501to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9502digits may be used upper or lower case.
9503
9504Example :
9505 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9506 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9507
9508
95097.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9510---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009511
9512IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9513netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9514within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009515host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009516difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9517at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9518does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9519parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009520
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009521IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9522Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9523trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9524IPv6 patterns.
9525
9526HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9527following situations :
9528 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9529 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9530 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9531 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9532 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9533 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9534 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9535 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9536 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9537 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009539
95407.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9541----------------------------------
9542
9543Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9544combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9545
9546 - AND (implicit)
9547 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9548 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009550A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009552 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009554Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9555indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009557For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9558"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9559requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9560is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9561
9562 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9563 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9564 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9565 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9566
9567To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9568and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9569
9570 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9571 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9572 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9573 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9574
9575 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9576 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9577 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9578 use_backend www if host_www
9579
9580It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9581expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9582be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9583the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9584
9585 The following rule :
9586
9587 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9588 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9589
9590 Can also be written that way :
9591
9592 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9593
9594It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9595to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9596simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9597sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9598good use is the following :
9599
9600 With named ACLs :
9601
9602 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9603 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9604 monitor fail if site_dead
9605
9606 With anonymous ACLs :
9607
9608 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9609
9610See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9611
9612
96137.3. Fetching samples
9614---------------------
9615
9616Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9617against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9618sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9619ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9620of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9621available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9622
9623This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9624Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9625compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9626deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9627
9628The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9629matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9630method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9631indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9632
9633As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9634when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9635mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9636the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9637ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9638
9639Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9640multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9641when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9642incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9643are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9644is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9645all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9646
9647Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9648 - name
9649 - name(arg1)
9650 - name(arg1,arg2)
9651
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009652
96537.3.1. Converters
9654-----------------
9655
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009656Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9657of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9658is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9659was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9660has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9661unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9662
9663These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9664sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9665the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9666support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009668The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009669
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009670base64
9671 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9672 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9673 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9674
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009675lower
9676 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9677 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9678 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009679
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009680upper
9681 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9682 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9683 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009684
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009685hex
9686 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9687 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9688 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9689 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009690
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009691ipmask(<mask>)
9692 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9693 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9694 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9695 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009696
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009697http_date([<offset>])
9698 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9699 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9700 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9701 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9702 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9703 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009704
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009705language(<value>[,<default>])
9706 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9707 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9708 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9709 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9710 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9711 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9712 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9713 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9714 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9715 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9716 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9717 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009718
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009719 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009720
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009721 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9722 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009723
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009724 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9725 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9726 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9727 use_backend spanish if es
9728 use_backend french if fr
9729 use_backend english if en
9730 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009731
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009732map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9733map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9734map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9735 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9736 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9737 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9738 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9739 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9740 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9741 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9742 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009743
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009744 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9745 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9746 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009747
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009748 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9749 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009750
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009751 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9752 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9753 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9754 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +02009755 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
9756 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009757 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9758 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9759 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9760 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9761 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9762 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9763 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9764 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9765 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9766 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9767 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9768 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9769 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9770 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009771
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009772 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9773 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9774 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9775 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9776 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009777
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009778 Example :
9779
9780 # this is a comment and is ignored
9781 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9782 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9783 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9784 | | | `---------- value
9785 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9786 | `---------------------------- key
9787 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9788
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009789
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020097907.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009791--------------------------------------------
9792
9793A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9794not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9795"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9796The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9797
9798always_false : boolean
9799 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9800 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9801
9802always_true : boolean
9803 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9804 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9805
9806avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009807 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009808 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9809 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9810 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9811 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9812 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9813 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9814 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9815 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9816 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9817 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9818 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9819 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9820 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009822be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009823 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9824 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9825 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9826 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9827 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009829be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9830 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9831 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9832 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9833 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9834 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9835 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009836
9837 Example :
9838 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9839 backend dynamic
9840 mode http
9841 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9842 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009844connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9845 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009846 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009847 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9848 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009849
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009850 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009851 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009852 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9853
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009854 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9855 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009856
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009857 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009858 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009859 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009860 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9861 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009862 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009863 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009864
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009865 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9866 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009867 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009868 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009869
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009870date([<offset>]) : integer
9871 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9872 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9873 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9874 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009875 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9876
9877 Example :
9878
9879 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9880 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009881
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009882env(<name>) : string
9883 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9884 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9885 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9886 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9887 certain way.
9888
9889 Examples :
9890 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9891 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9892
9893 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9894 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009896fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9897 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009898 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9899 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009900 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9901 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9902 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9903 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9904 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009906fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9907 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9908 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9909 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9910 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9911 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9912 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9913 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9914 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009915
9916 Example :
9917 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9918 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9919 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9920 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9921 frontend mail
9922 bind :25
9923 mode tcp
9924 maxconn 100
9925 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9926 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9927 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9928 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009930nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9932 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9933 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009934 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9935 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9936 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009938queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009939 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9940 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9941 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009942 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9943 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9944 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9945 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9946 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9947
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +01009948rand([<range>]) : integer
9949 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
9950 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
9951 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
9952 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
9953 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
9954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009955srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9956 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9957 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9958 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9959 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9960 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9961 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9962 methods.
9963
9964srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9965 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9966 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9967 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9968 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9969 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9970 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9971 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9972
9973srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9974 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9975 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009976 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009977 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9978 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9979 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9980 overloading servers).
9981
9982 Example :
9983 # Redirect to a separate back
9984 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9985 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9986 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9987
9988table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9989 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9990 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9991
9992table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9993 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9994 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9995 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9996
9997
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020099987.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009999----------------------------------
10000
10001The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10002closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10003methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10004sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10005TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010006the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10007counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10008"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010009argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10010the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10011this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010012
10013be_id : integer
10014 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10015 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10016
10017dst : ip
10018 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10019 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10020 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10021 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10022 RFC 4291.
10023
10024dst_conn : integer
10025 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10026 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10027 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10028 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10029 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10030 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10031 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10032 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010034dst_port : integer
10035 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10036 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10037 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10038 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10039 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10040 an HTTP header.
10041
10042fe_id : integer
10043 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10044 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10045 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10046
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010047sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010048sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10049sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10050sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010051 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10052 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10053 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10054
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010055sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010056sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10057sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10058sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010059 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10060 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10061 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10062
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010063sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010064sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10065sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10066sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010067 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10068 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010069 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10070 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10071 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010072
10073 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10074 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010075 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10076 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10077 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010078 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10079 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10080
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010081sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010082sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10083sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10084sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010085 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10086 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10087
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010088sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010089sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10090sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10091sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010092 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10093 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10094 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10095
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010096sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010097sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10098sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10099sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010100 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10101 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10102 See also src_conn_rate.
10103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010104sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010105sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10106sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10107sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010108 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010109 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010110
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010111sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010112sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10113sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10114sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010115 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10116 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10117 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010118 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10119 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10120 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010121
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010122sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010123sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10124sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10125sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010126 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10127 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10128 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10129
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010130sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010131sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10132sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10133sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010134 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10135 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10136 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10137 src_http_err_rate.
10138
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010139sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010140sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10141sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10142sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010143 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10144 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10145 src_http_req_cnt.
10146
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010147sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010148sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10149sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10150sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010151 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10152 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10153 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10154 src_http_req_rate.
10155
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010156sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010157sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10158sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10159sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010160 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010161 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10162 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10163 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10164 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010165
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010166 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10167 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010168 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10169
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010170sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010171sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10172sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10173sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010174 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10175 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10176 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10177 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10178
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010179sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010180sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10181sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10182sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010183 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10184 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10185 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10186 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10187
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010188sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010189sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10190sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10191sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010192 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10193 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10194 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10195 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010196 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010197 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10198
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010199sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010200sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10201sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10202sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010203 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10204 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10205 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10206 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10207 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010208 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010209
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010210sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010211sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10212sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10213sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010214 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10215 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10216 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10217
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010218sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010219sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10220sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10221sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010222 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10223 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010224 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010225 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10226 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010227 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10228 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10229 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010231so_id : integer
10232 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10233 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10234 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010236src : ip
10237 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10238 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10239 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10240 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10241 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10242 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10243 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010244
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010245 Example:
10246 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10247 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010249src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10250 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10251 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10252 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010253 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010255src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10256 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10257 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010258 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010259 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010261src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10262 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10263 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10264 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10265 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10266 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10267 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010268
10269 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10270 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10271 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10272 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010273 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010274 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10275 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010277src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010278 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010279 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010280 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010281 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010283src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010284 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010285 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10286 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010287 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010289src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10290 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10291 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10292 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010293 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010295src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010296 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010297 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010298 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010299 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010301src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010302 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010303 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010304 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10305 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010306 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10307 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10308 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010310src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10311 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10312 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010313 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010314 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010315 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010317src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10318 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10319 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10320 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10321 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010322 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010324src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10325 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10326 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10327 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010328 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010330src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10331 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10332 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10333 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010334 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010335 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010337src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10338 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10339 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10340 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010341 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010342 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10343 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010344
10345 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010346 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010347 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010349src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10350 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10351 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10352 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10353 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010354 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10355 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010357src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10358 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10359 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010360 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10361 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010362 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010364src_port : integer
10365 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10366 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10367 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10368 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010370src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10371 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010372 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10373 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10374 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010375 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010377src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10378 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10379 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10380 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10381 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010382 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010384src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10385 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10386 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10387 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10388 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10389 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10390 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10391 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10392 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010393
10394 Example :
10395 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10396 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10397 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10398 listen ssh
10399 bind :22
10400 mode tcp
10401 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010402 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010403 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010404 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010406srv_id : integer
10407 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10408 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10409 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010410
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010411
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104127.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010413----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010415The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10416closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10417when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10418usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010419future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010420
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010421ssl_bc : boolean
10422 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10423 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10424 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10425
10426ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10427 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10428 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10429
10430ssl_bc_cipher : string
10431 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10432 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10433
10434ssl_bc_protocol : string
10435 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10436 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10437
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010438ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010439 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010440 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10441 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010442
10443ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10444 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10445 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10446 if session was reused or not.
10447
10448ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10449 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10450 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010452ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10453 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10454 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10455 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10456 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10457 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010459ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10460 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10461 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10462 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10463 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010465ssl_c_err : integer
10466 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10467 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10468 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10469 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10470 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010472ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10473 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10474 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10475 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10476 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10477 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10478 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10479 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10480 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010482ssl_c_key_alg : string
10483 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10484 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10485 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010487ssl_c_notafter : string
10488 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10489 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10490 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010492ssl_c_notbefore : string
10493 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10494 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10495 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010497ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10498 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10499 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10500 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10501 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10502 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10503 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10504 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10505 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010507ssl_c_serial : binary
10508 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10509 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10510 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010512ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10513 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10514 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10515 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010517ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10518 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10519 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10520 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010522ssl_c_used : boolean
10523 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10524 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010526ssl_c_verify : integer
10527 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10528 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10529 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10530 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010532ssl_c_version : integer
10533 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10534 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010536ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10537 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10538 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10539 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10540 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010541 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010542 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10543 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10544 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010546ssl_f_key_alg : string
10547 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10548 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10549 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010551ssl_f_notafter : string
10552 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10553 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10554 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010556ssl_f_notbefore : string
10557 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10558 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10559 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010561ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10562 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10563 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10564 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10565 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10566 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10567 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10568 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10569 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010571ssl_f_serial : binary
10572 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10573 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10574 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010575
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010576ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10577 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10578 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10579 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10582 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10583 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10584 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010586ssl_f_version : integer
10587 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10588 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10589
10590ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010591 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10592 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10593 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010595 Example :
10596 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10597 listen http-https
10598 bind :80
10599 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10600 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10601
10602ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10603 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10604 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10605
10606ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010607 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010608 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10609 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10610 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10611 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10612 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10613 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10614 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10615 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010617ssl_fc_cipher : string
10618 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10619 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010621ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010622 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10623 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010624 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10625 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10626 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10627 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010629ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10630 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010631 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10632 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10633 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10634 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010636ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010637 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010638 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10639 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10640 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10641 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10642 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10643 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10644 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010646ssl_fc_protocol : string
10647 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10648 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010649
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010650ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010651 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010652 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10653 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010655ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10656 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10657 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10658 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10659 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010661ssl_fc_sni : string
10662 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10663 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10664 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10665 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10666 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10667
10668 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10669 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10670 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010671 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10672 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010674 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010675 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10676 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010678ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10679 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10680 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010681
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010682
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010684------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010686Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10687sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10688only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10689For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10690be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10691can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10692sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10693for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10694content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010696payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10697 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10698 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10699 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010701payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10702 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10703 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10704 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010706req.len : integer
10707req_len : integer (deprecated)
10708 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10709 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10710 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10711 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10712 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10713 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10714 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10715 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010717req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10718 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010719 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10720 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10721 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10722 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010724 ACL alternatives :
10725 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010727req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10728 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10729 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10730 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10731 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010733 ACL alternatives :
10734 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010736 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010738req.proto_http : boolean
10739req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10740 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10741 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10742 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10743 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10744 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10745 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10746 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010748 Example:
10749 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10750 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10751 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010752 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010754req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10755rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10756 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10757 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10758 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10759 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10760 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10761 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10762 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010764 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10765 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10766 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10767 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10768 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10769 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010771 ACL derivatives :
10772 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010774 Example :
10775 listen tse-farm
10776 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10777 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10778 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10779 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10780 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10781 persist rdp-cookie
10782 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10783 # This is only useful makes sense if
10784 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10785 stick-table type string size 204800
10786 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10787 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10788 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010790 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10791 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010793req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10794rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10795 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10796 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10797 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10798 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010800 ACL derivatives :
10801 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010803req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10804req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10805 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10806 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10807 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10808 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10809 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10810 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10811 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010813req.ssl_sni : string
10814req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10815 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10816 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10817 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10818 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10819 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10820 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10821 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10822 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10823 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10824 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10825 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10826 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010828 ACL derivatives :
10829 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010831 Examples :
10832 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10833 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10834 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10835 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10836 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010838res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10839rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10840 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10841 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10842 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10843 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10844 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10845 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10846 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010848req.ssl_ver : integer
10849req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10850 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10851 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10852 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10853 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10854 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10855 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10856 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10857 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10858 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010860 ACL derivatives :
10861 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010862
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010863res.len : integer
10864 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10865 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10866 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10867 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10868 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10869 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10870 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10871 content inspection.
10872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010873res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10874 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010875 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10876 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10877 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10878 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010880res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10881 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10882 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10883 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10884 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010886 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010888wait_end : boolean
10889 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10890 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10891 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10892 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10893 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10894 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10895 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10896 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010898 Examples :
10899 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10900 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10901 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010903 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10904 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10905 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10906 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10907 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10908 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10909 tcp-request content reject
10910
10911
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109127.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010913--------------------------------------
10914
10915It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10916This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10917data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10918its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10919HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10920content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10921to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10922more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10923response are indexed.
10924
10925base : string
10926 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10927 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10928 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10929 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10930 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10931 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10932 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10933 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10934
10935 ACL derivatives :
10936 base : exact string match
10937 base_beg : prefix match
10938 base_dir : subdir match
10939 base_dom : domain match
10940 base_end : suffix match
10941 base_len : length match
10942 base_reg : regex match
10943 base_sub : substring match
10944
10945base32 : integer
10946 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10947 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10948 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10949 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10950
10951base32+src : binary
10952 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10953 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10954 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10955 per-URL counters.
10956
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010957capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10958 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10959 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10960 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
10961
10962capture.req.method : string
10963 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
10964 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
10965 because it's allocated.
10966
10967capture.req.uri : string
10968 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
10969 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
10970 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
10971 allocated.
10972
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010973capture.req.ver : string
10974 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10975 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
10976 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
10977
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010978capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10979 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10980 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10981 The first entry is an index of 0.
10982 See also: "capture response header"
10983
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010984capture.res.ver : string
10985 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10986 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
10987 persistent flag.
10988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010989req.cook([<name>]) : string
10990cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10991 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10992 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10993 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10994 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10995 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10996 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10997 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10998 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10999
11000 ACL derivatives :
11001 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11002 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11003 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11004 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11005 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11006 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11007 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11008 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011010req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11011cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11012 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11013 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011015req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11016cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11017 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11018 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11019 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11020 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011022cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11023 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11024 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11025 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11026 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11027 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11028 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11029 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11030 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11031 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11032 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011034hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11035 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11036 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11037 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11038 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011039 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011041req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11042 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11043 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11044 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11045 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11046 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11047 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11048 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11049 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011051req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11052 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11053 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11054 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11055 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011057req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11058 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11059 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11060 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11061 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11062 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11063 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11064 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11065 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11066 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11067 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11068 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011070 ACL derivatives :
11071 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11072 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11073 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11074 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11075 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11076 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11077 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11078 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11079
11080req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11081hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11082 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11083 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11084 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11085 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11086 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11087 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11088 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11089 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11090 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11091
11092req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11093hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11094 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11095 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11096 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11097 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11098 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11099 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11100 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11101 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11102
11103req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11104hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11105 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11106 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11107 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11108 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11109 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11110 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11111 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11112
11113http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11114 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11115 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11116 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11117 basic auth is supported.
11118
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011119http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11120 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11121 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11122 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11123 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011124 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11125 basic auth is supported.
11126
11127 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011128 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11129 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11130 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11131 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011132
11133http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011134 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11135 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011136 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11137 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011139method : integer + string
11140 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11141 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11142 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11143 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11144 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11145 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11146 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011148 ACL derivatives :
11149 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011151 Example :
11152 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11153 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11154 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011156path : string
11157 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11158 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11159 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11160 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11161 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11162 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11163 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011165 ACL derivatives :
11166 path : exact string match
11167 path_beg : prefix match
11168 path_dir : subdir match
11169 path_dom : domain match
11170 path_end : suffix match
11171 path_len : length match
11172 path_reg : regex match
11173 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011175req.ver : string
11176req_ver : string (deprecated)
11177 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11178 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11179 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011181 ACL derivatives :
11182 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011184res.comp : boolean
11185 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11186 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11187 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011189res.comp_algo : string
11190 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11191 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11192 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011194res.cook([<name>]) : string
11195scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11196 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11197 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11198 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011200 ACL derivatives :
11201 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011203res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11204scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11205 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11206 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11207 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011209res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11210scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11211 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11212 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11213 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011215res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11216 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11217 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11218 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11219 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11220 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11221 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11222 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11223 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11224 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011226res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11227 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11228 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11229 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11230 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11231 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011233res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11234shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11235 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11236 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11237 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11238 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11239 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11240 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11241 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11242 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011244 ACL derivatives :
11245 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11246 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11247 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11248 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11249 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11250 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11251 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11252 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11253
11254res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11255shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11256 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11257 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11258 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11259 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11260 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011262res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11263shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11264 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11265 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11266 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11267 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11268 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11269 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011271res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11272shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11273 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11274 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11275 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11276 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11277 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11278 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011280res.ver : string
11281resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11282 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11283 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011285 ACL derivatives :
11286 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011288set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11289 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11290 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11291 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11292 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011294 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11295 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011297 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011299status : integer
11300 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11301 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11302 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011304url : string
11305 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11306 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11307 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11308 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11309 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11310 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11311 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011313 ACL derivatives :
11314 url : exact string match
11315 url_beg : prefix match
11316 url_dir : subdir match
11317 url_dom : domain match
11318 url_end : suffix match
11319 url_len : length match
11320 url_reg : regex match
11321 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011323url_ip : ip
11324 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11325 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11326 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11327 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11328 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11329 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11330 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011332url_port : integer
11333 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11334 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11335 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11336 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011338urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11339url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11340 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11341 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11342 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11343 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11344 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11345 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11346 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11347 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11348 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011350 ACL derivatives :
11351 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11352 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11353 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11354 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11355 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11356 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11357 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11358 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011359
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011361 Example :
11362 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11363 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11364 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11365 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011367urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11368 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11369 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11370 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011371
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113737.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011374---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011376Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11377every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011378order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011380ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11381---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011382FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011383HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011384HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11385HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011386HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11387HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11388HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11389HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11390LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011391METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11392METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11393METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11394METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11395METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11396METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011397RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011398REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011399TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011400WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11401---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011402
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114048. Logging
11405----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011406
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011407One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11408provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11409very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11410provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11411state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011412to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011413headers.
11414
11415In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11416about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11417send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11418
11419 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11420 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11421 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11422 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11423 at the termination.
11424
11425The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11426allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11427as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11428while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11429real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11430delay.
11431
11432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114338.1. Log levels
11434---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011435
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011436TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011437source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011438HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11439in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11440track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11441syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11442about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011443
11444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114458.2. Log formats
11446----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011447
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011448HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011449and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11450slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11451options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011452
11453 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11454 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11455 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11456 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11457 extents.
11458
11459 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11460 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11461 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11462 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11463 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11464
11465 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11466 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11467 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11468 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11469 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11470
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011471 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11472 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11473 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11474 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11475
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011476 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11477
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011478Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11479specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11480field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11481servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11482always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11483identifier.
11484
11485Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11486 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11487 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11488 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11489 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11490
11491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114928.2.1. Default log format
11493-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011494
11495This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11496as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11497format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11498
11499 Example :
11500 listen www
11501 mode http
11502 log global
11503 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11504
11505 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11506 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11507 (www/HTTP)
11508
11509 Field Format Extract from the example above
11510 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11511 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11512 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11513 4 'to' to
11514 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11515 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11516
11517Detailed fields description :
11518 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11519 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11520 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11521 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11522 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11523 and processed the connection.
11524 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11525
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011526In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11527"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11528connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11529
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011530It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11531will eventually disappear.
11532
11533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115348.2.2. TCP log format
11535---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011536
11537The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11538is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11539information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11540counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11541emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11542environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11543the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11544sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011545specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11546not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11547fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11548marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011549
11550 Example :
11551 frontend fnt
11552 mode tcp
11553 option tcplog
11554 log global
11555 default_backend bck
11556
11557 backend bck
11558 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11559
11560 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11561 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11562 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11563
11564 Field Format Extract from the example above
11565 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11566 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11567 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11568 4 frontend_name fnt
11569 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11570 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11571 7 bytes_read* 212
11572 8 termination_state --
11573 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11574 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11575
11576Detailed fields description :
11577 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011578 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11579 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11580 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11581 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11582 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011583
11584 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011585 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11586 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11587 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011588
11589 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11590 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11591 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11592 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11593
11594 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11595 and processed the connection.
11596
11597 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11598 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11599 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11600 applications.
11601
11602 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11603 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11604 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11605 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11606 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11607
11608 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11609 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11610 See "Timers" below for more details.
11611
11612 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11613 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11614 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11615 "Timers" below for more details.
11616
11617 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011618 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011619 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11620 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11621 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11622 details.
11623
11624 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11625 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11626 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11627 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11628 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11629
11630 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11631 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11632 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11633 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11634 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11635 for more details.
11636
11637 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011638 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011639 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11640 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11641 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011642 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011643
11644 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11645 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11646 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11647 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11648 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11649 caused by a denial of service attack.
11650
11651 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11652 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11653 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11654 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11655 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11656 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11657 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11658 denial of service attack.
11659
11660 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11661 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11662 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11663 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11664 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11665 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11666 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11667 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11668 be processed than on other servers.
11669
11670 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11671 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11672 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11673 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11674 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11675 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11676 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11677 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11678 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11679 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11680 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11681 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11682 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11683
11684 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11685 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11686 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11687 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11688 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11689 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11690 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11691 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11692
11693 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11694 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11695 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11696 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11697 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11698 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11699 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11700 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11701 occurs.
11702
11703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117048.2.3. HTTP log format
11705----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011706
11707The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11708is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11709the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11710are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11711emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11712generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11713"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11714which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011715frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11716is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011717
11718Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11719slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11720with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11721
11722 Example :
11723 frontend http-in
11724 mode http
11725 option httplog
11726 log global
11727 default_backend bck
11728
11729 backend static
11730 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11731
11732 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11733 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11734 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011735 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011736
11737 Field Format Extract from the example above
11738 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11739 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11740 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11741 4 frontend_name http-in
11742 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11743 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11744 7 status_code 200
11745 8 bytes_read* 2750
11746 9 captured_request_cookie -
11747 10 captured_response_cookie -
11748 11 termination_state ----
11749 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11750 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11751 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11752 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11753 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011754
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011755
11756Detailed fields description :
11757 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011758 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11759 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11760 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11761 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11762 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011763
11764 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011765 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11766 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11767 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011768
11769 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11770 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11771 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11772 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11773 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11774
11775 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11776 and processed the connection.
11777
11778 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11779 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11780 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11781
11782 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11783 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11784 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11785 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11786 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11787 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11788
11789 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11790 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11791 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11792 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11793 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11794 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11795
11796 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11797 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11798 See "Timers" below for more details.
11799
11800 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11801 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11802 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11803 below for more details.
11804
11805 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11806 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11807 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11808 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11809 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11810 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11811 for more details.
11812
11813 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011814 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011815 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11816 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11817 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11818 details.
11819
11820 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11821 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11822 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11823
11824 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11825 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11826 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11827 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11828 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11829 overflowing.
11830
11831 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11832 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11833 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11834 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11835 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11836 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11837 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11838 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11839
11840 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11841 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11842 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11843 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11844 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11845 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11846 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11847 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11848
11849 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11850 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11851 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11852 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11853 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11854 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11855 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11856
11857 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011858 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011859 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11860 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11861 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011862 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011863 system.
11864
11865 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11866 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11867 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11868 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11869 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11870 caused by a denial of service attack.
11871
11872 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11873 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11874 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11875 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11876 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11877 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11878 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11879 denial of service attack.
11880
11881 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11882 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11883 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11884 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11885 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11886 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11887 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11888 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11889 processed than on other servers.
11890
11891 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11892 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11893 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11894 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11895 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11896 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11897 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11898 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11899 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11900 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11901 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11902 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11903 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11904
11905 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11906 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11907 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11908 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11909 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11910 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11911 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11912 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11913
11914 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11915 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11916 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11917 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11918 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11919 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11920 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11921 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11922 occurs.
11923
11924 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11925 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11926 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11927 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11928 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11929 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11930 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11931 cookies" below for more details.
11932
11933 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11934 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11935 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11936 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11937 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11938 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11939 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11940 and cookies" below for more details.
11941
11942 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11943 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11944 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11945 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11946 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11947 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11948 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11949 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11950
11951
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200119528.2.4. Custom log format
11953------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011954
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011955The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011956mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011957
11958HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11959Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11960separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11961prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11962
11963Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11964variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11965string formats ("Q").
11966
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011967If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011968as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011969less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11970the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11971
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011972Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011973In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011974in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011975
11976Flags are :
11977 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011978 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011979
11980 Example:
11981
11982 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11983 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11984
11985At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11986
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011987 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11988 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011989
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011990the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011991
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011992 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011993 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011994 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011995
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011996and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11997
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011998 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011999 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12000
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012001Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12002
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012003 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012004 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012005 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12006 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12007 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012008 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12009 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12010 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012011 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012012 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012013 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012014 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012015 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012016 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012017 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12018 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012019 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012020 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12021 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012022 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012023 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12024 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012025 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12026 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12027 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012028 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012029 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12030 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012031 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012032 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12033 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12034 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012035 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012036 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12037 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12038 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12039 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012040 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012041 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012042 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012043 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012044 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012045 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012046 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12047 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12048 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012049 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012050 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12051 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012052 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012053 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012054 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012055 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012056
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012057 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012058
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012059
120608.2.5. Error log format
12061-----------------------
12062
12063When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12064protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12065By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12066"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12067will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12068logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12069
12070The format looks like this :
12071
12072 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12073 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12074 Connection error during SSL handshake
12075
12076 Field Format Extract from the example above
12077 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12078 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12079 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12080 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12081 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12082
12083These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12084failures.
12085
12086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120878.3. Advanced logging options
12088-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012089
12090Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12091just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12092options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12093for more information about their usage.
12094
12095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12097------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012098
12099It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12100haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12101commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12102monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12103ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12104
12105 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12106 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12107 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12108 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12109
12110 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12111 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12112 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012113 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012114 such as other load-balancers.
12115
12116 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12117 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12118 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12119
12120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121218.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12122----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012123
12124The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12125what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12126or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12127"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12128just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12129log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12130after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12131is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12132with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12133with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12134
12135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121368.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12137------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012138
12139Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12140for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12141"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12142retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12143raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12144a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12145file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12146you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12147"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12148
12149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121508.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12151--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012152
12153Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12154multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12155them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12156"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12157logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12158error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12159and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12160too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12161useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12162alternative.
12163
12164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121658.4. Timing events
12166------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012167
12168Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12169reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12170the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12171frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12172mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12173
12174 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12175 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12176 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12177 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12178 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12179
12180 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12181 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12182 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12183 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12184 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12185
12186 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12187 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12188 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12189 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12190 connection never established.
12191
12192 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12193 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12194 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12195 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12196 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12197 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12198 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12199 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12200 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12201 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12202 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12203
12204 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12205 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12206 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12207 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012208 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012209
12210 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12211
12212 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12213 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12214 negative.
12215
12216These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12217protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12218that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012219due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012220close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12221session has been aborted on timeout.
12222
12223Most common cases :
12224
12225 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12226 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12227 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12228 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12229 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12230 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12231 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12232 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12233 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012234 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12235 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12236 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012237
12238 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12239 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12240 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12241 of ms on remote networks.
12242
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012243 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12244 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12245 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012246
12247 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12248 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12249 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12250 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12251 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12252 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12253 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12254 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12255 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12256 to the server until another one is released.
12257
12258Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12259
12260 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12261 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12262 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12263
12264 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12265 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12266 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12267
12268 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12269 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12270 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12271 flags.
12272
12273 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12274 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12275 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12276 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12277 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12278 the client connection was maintained open.
12279
12280 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012281 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012282 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12283 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12284
12285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122868.5. Session state at disconnection
12287-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012288
12289TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12290"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
122912-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12292each of which has a special meaning :
12293
12294 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12295 session to terminate :
12296
12297 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12298
12299 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12300 server explicitly refused it.
12301
12302 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12303 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12304 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12305 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012306 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12307
12308 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12309 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012310
12311 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12312 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12313 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12314 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12315 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12316
12317 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12318 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12319 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12320 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12321 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12322
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012323 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12324 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12325
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012326 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12327 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12328 backup connections when going up.
12329
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012330 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12331
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012332 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12333 send or receive data.
12334
12335 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12336 send or receive data.
12337
12338 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12339 with nothing left in the buffers.
12340
12341 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12342
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012343 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012344 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12345
12346 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12347 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12348 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12349 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12350 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12351
12352 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12353 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12354
12355 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12356 server (HTTP only).
12357
12358 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12359
12360 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12361 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12362 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12363
12364 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12365 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12366 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12367
12368 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12369
12370 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12371 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12372
12373 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12374 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12375 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12376
12377 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12378 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012379 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12380 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012381
12382 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12383 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12384 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12385 another server.
12386
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012387 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012388 server.
12389
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012390 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12391 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12392 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12393 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12394
12395 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12396 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12397 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12398 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12399
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012400 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12401 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12402 "use-server" rule).
12403
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012404 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12405
12406 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12407 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12408
12409 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12410
12411 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12412 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12413 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12414
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012415 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12416 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012417 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012418 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12419 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12420
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012421 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12422
12423 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12424 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12425
12426 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12427
12428 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12429
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012430The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12431was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012432helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12433starvation, attacks, etc...
12434
12435The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12436alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12437easier finding and understanding.
12438
12439 Flags Reason
12440
12441 -- Normal termination.
12442
12443 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12444 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12445 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12446 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12447
12448 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12449 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12450 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12451 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12452 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12453 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012454
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012455 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12456 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012457 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012458
12459 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12460 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12461 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12462
12463 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12464 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12465 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12466 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12467 the server takes too long to respond.
12468
12469 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12470 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12471 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12472 long a time to respond.
12473
12474 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12475 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12476 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12477 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12478 and the client.
12479
12480 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12481 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12482 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12483 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12484 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12485 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12486
12487 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12488 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012489 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12490 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12491 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12492 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012493
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012494 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12495 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012497 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012498 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12499 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12500 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12501 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12502 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12503
12504 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12505 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12506 503 or 504 here.
12507
12508 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12509 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12510 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12511 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12512 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12513
12514 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12515 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012516 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012517 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12518 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12519
12520 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12521 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12522 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12523 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12524 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12525 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12526 between haproxy and the server.
12527
12528 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12529 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12530 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12531 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12532 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12533 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12534 solution is to fix the application.
12535
12536 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12537 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12538 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12539 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12540 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12541 external attacks.
12542
12543 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12544 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012545 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012546 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12547 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12548
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012549 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12550 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12551 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012552 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12553 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012554
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012555 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12556 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12557 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12558 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012559 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12560 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12561 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12562 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12563 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012564
12565 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12566 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12567 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12568 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12569
12570 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12571 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12572 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12573 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12574
12575 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12576 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12577 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12578 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12579
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012580The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12581persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12582important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12583re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12584
12585 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12586
12587 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12588 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12589 set on a GET request.
12590
12591 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12592 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012593 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012594 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12595
12596 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12597 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12598 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12599
12600 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12601 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12602 already got a cookie.
12603
12604 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12605 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12606 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12607 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12608 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12609
12610 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12611 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12612 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12613
12614 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12615 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12616 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12617
12618 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12619 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12620
12621 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12622 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12623 then advertised in the response.
12624
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126268.6. Non-printable characters
12627-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012628
12629In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12630consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12631converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12632prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12633being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12634escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12635is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12636'}' when logging headers.
12637
12638Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12639issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12640containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12641
12642Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12643the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12644performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12645
12646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126478.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12648---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012649
12650Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12651achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012652section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012653cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12654the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12655the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012656locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012657not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12658user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12659a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12660wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12661
12662 Examples :
12663 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12664 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12665
12666 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12667 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12668
12669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126708.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12671---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012672
12673Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12674proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12675the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12676server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12677
12678Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12679response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012680section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012681
12682It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012683time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12684appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012685are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12686and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12687follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12688request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12689in the logs.
12690
12691 Example :
12692 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12693 listen proxy-out
12694 mode http
12695 option httplog
12696 option logasap
12697 log global
12698 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12699
12700 # log the name of the virtual server
12701 capture request header Host len 20
12702
12703 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12704 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12705
12706 # log the beginning of the referrer
12707 capture request header Referer len 20
12708
12709 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12710 capture response header Server len 20
12711
12712 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12713 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12714
12715 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12716 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12717
12718 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12719 capture response header Via len 20
12720
12721 # log the URL location during a redirection
12722 capture response header Location len 20
12723
12724 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12725 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12726 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12727 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12728 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12729
12730 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12731 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12732 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12733 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012734 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012735
12736 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12737 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12738 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12739 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12740 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012741 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012742
12743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127448.9. Examples of logs
12745---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012746
12747These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12748them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12749reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12750
12751 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12752 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12753 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12754
12755 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12756 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12757
12758 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12759 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12760 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12761
12762 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12763 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12764
12765 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12766 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12767 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12768
12769 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012770 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012771 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12772 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12773
12774 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12775 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12776 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12777
12778 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12779 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012780 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012781 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12782 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12783 to return the 502 and not the server.
12784
12785 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012786 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012787
12788 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12789 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12790 Nothing was sent to any server.
12791
12792 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12793 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12794
12795 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12796 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12797 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12798 send a 408 return code to the client.
12799
12800 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12801 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12802
12803 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12804 5 seconds ("c----").
12805
12806 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12807 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012808 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012809
12810 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012811 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012812 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12813 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12814 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12815 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12816 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012817
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128199. Statistics and monitoring
12820----------------------------
12821
12822It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12823mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12824CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12825Unix socket.
12826
12827
128289.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012829---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012830
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012831The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12832page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012834 0. pxname: proxy name
12835 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12836 for server)
12837 2. qcur: current queued requests
12838 3. qmax: max queued requests
12839 4. scur: current sessions
12840 5. smax: max sessions
12841 6. slim: sessions limit
12842 7. stot: total sessions
12843 8. bin: bytes in
12844 9. bout: bytes out
12845 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012846 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012847 12. ereq: request errors
12848 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012849 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012850 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12851 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012852 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012853 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12854 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12855 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12856 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12857 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12858 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12859 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12860 25. qlimit: queue limit
12861 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12862 27. iid: unique proxy id
12863 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12864 29. throttle: warm up status
12865 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12866 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012867 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012868 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12869 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12870 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012871 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012872 UNK -> unknown
12873 INI -> initializing
12874 SOCKERR -> socket error
12875 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12876 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12877 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12878 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12879 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12880 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12881 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12882 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12883 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12884 disable-on-404
12885 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12886 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12887 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012888 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12889 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012890 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12891 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12892 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12893 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12894 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12895 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012896 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12897 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12898 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12899 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012900 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12901 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012902 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12903 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12904 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012905 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012906 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012907
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129099.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012910-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012911
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012912The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12913necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12914A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12915issuing commands by hand :
12916
12917 global
12918 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12919 stats timeout 2m
12920
12921It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12922the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12923never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12924situations :
12925
12926 global
12927 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12928 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12929 stats timeout 2m
12930
12931To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12932swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12933to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12934syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12935
12936 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12937 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12938
12939The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12940script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12941for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12942
12943The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12944that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12945editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12946(eg: watch a counter).
12947
12948The socket supports two operation modes :
12949 - interactive
12950 - non-interactive
12951
12952The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12953this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12954sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12955mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12956commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12957example :
12958
12959 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12960
12961The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12962entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12963for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12964sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12965"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12966after processing the last command of the same line.
12967
12968For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12969"prompt" command :
12970
12971 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12972 prompt
12973 > show info
12974 ...
12975 >
12976
12977Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12978delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12979that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12980parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012981
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012982It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12983on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12984own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012985
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012986The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12987If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12988all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12989it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12990
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012991add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012992 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
12993 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
12994 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
12995 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012996
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012997add map <map> <key> <value>
12998 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12999 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013000 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13001 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13002 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013003
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013004clear counters
13005 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13006 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13007 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13008 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13009 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13010
13011clear counters all
13012 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13013 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13014 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13015
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013016clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013017 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13018 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13019 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013020
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013021clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013022 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13023 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13024 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013025
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013026clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13027 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13028
13029 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13030 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13031 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13032 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13033 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13034 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13035
13036 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13037
13038 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13039 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13040 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13041 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13042 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13043 the ACLs :
13044
13045 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13046 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13047 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13048 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13049 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13050 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13051
13052 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013053 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13054 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013055
13056 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013057 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013058 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013059 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13060 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13061 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13062 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013063
13064 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13065
13066 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013067 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013068 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13069 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013070 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13071 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13072 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013073
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013074del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13075 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013076 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13077 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13078 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13079 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013080
13081del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013082 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013083 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13084 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13085 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13086 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013087
13088disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013089 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13090
13091 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13092 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13093 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13094 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13095 re-enabled using enable agent.
13096
13097 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13098 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13099 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13100 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13101 otherwise unchanged.
13102
13103 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13104 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13105 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13106
13107 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13108 level "admin".
13109
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013110disable frontend <frontend>
13111 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13112 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13113 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13114 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13115 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13116 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13117 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13118 on the stats page.
13119
13120 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13121 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13122
13123 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13124 level "admin".
13125
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013126disable server <backend>/<server>
13127 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13128 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13129 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13130 during the maintenance.
13131
13132 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13133 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13134
13135 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013136 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013137
13138 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13139 level "admin".
13140
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013141enable agent <backend>/<server>
13142 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13143
13144 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13145 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13146
13147 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13148 level "admin".
13149
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013150enable frontend <frontend>
13151 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13152 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13153 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13154 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13155 which was disabled.
13156
13157 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13158 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13159
13160 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13161 level "admin".
13162
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013163enable server <backend>/<server>
13164 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13165 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13166
13167 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013168 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013169
13170 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13171 level "admin".
13172
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013173get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013174get acl <acl> <value>
13175 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13176 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13177 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13178 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13179 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013180
13181 The first two words are:
13182
13183 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13184 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13185 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13186
13187 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13188
13189 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13190
13191 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13192
13193 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13194 interpretation of the case.
13195
13196 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13197 useful with regular expressions.
13198
13199 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13200 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13201
13202 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13203 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13204 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13205
13206 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13207
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013208get weight <backend>/<server>
13209 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13210 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13211 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13212 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13213 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013214 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013215
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013216help
13217 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13218 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013219
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013220prompt
13221 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13222 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13223 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13224 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13225 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13226 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13227 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13228 command.
13229
13230quit
13231 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013232
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013233set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013234 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13235 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13236 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013237
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013238set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013239 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13240 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13241 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13242 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13243 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013244 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13245 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13246
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013247set maxconn global <maxconn>
13248 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13249 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13250 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13251 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13252 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13253 setting.
13254
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013255set rate-limit connections global <value>
13256 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13257 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13258 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13259 is passed in number of connections per second.
13260
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013261set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13262 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13263 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013264 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13265 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013266
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013267set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13268 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13269 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13270 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13271 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13272
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013273set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13274 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13275 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13276 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13277 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13278 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13279
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013280set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013281 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13282 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13283 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13284 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013285 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13286 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013287
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013288set timeout cli <delay>
13289 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13290 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13291 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13292
13293set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13294 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13295 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013296 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13297 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13298 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13299 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13300 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13301 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13302 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13303 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13304 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13305 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13306 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13307 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13308 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013309
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013310show errors [<iid>]
13311 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13312 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013313 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13314 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13315 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013316
13317 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13318 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13319 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13320 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13321 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13322 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13323 are reported too.
13324
13325 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13326 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13327 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13328 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13329 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13330 code.
13331
13332 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13333 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13334 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13335 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13336 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13337 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13338 line.
13339
13340 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013341 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13342 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013343 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13344 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13345
13346 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13347 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13348 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13349 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13350 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13351 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13352 00204+ minal\r\n
13353 00211 \r\n
13354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013355 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013356 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13357 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13358 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13359 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13360 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13361 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013362
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013363show info
13364 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13365
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013366show map [<map>]
13367 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013368 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13369 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13370 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13371 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13372 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13373 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013374
13375show acl [<acl>]
13376 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013377 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13378 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13379 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13380 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13381 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013382
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013383show pools
13384 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13385 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13386 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13387 the pools.
13388
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013389show sess
13390 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013391 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13392 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13393
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013394show sess <id>
13395 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13396 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13397 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13398 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13399 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013400 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13401 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13402 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013403
13404show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13405 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13406 possible to dump only selected items :
13407 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13408 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13409 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13410 for example:
13411 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13412 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13413 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13414
13415 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013416 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13417 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013418 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13419 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13420 Nbproc: 1
13421 Process_num: 1
13422 (...)
13423
13424 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13425 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13426 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13427 (...)
13428 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13429
13430 $
13431
13432 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13433 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13434 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13435 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013436 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013437
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013438show table
13439 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13440 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13441 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13442 entries currently in use.
13443
13444 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013445 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013446 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13447 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013448
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013449show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013450 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13451 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13452 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013453 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13454
13455 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13456 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13457 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13458 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13459 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13460
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013461 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13462 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13463 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13464 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13465 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13466 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13467
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013468
13469 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013470 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13471 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013472
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013473 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013474 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013475 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013476 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13477 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13478 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13479 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013480
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013481 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013482 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013483 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13484 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013485
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013486 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13487 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013488 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013489 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13490 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013491
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013492 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13493 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013494 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013495 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13496 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13497
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013498 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13499 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13500 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13501 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13502 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13503
13504 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13505 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13506 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013507 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13508 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013509 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13510 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013511
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013512shutdown frontend <frontend>
13513 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13514 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13515 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13516 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13517 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13518 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13519 once it is terminated.
13520
13521 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13522 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13523
13524 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13525 level "admin".
13526
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013527shutdown session <id>
13528 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13529 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13530 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13531 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13532 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13533 flag in the logs.
13534
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013535shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13536 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13537 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13538 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13539 'K' flag in the logs.
13540
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013541/*
13542 * Local variables:
13543 * fill-column: 79
13544 * End:
13545 */